jtag/hla, jtag/stlink: switch to command 'adapter serial'
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla, jlink, kitprog, presto, st-link, vsllink, xds110.
2375 @end deffn
2376
2377 @section Interface Drivers
2378
2379 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2380 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2381 available at run time.
2382
2383 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2384 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2385 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2386 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2389 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2390 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2394 Displays status of RTCK option.
2395 Optionally sets that option first.
2396 @end deffn
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2400 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2401 This has one driver-specific command:
2402
2403 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2404 Logs some status
2405 @end deffn
2406 @end deffn
2407
2408 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2409 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2410 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2411 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2412 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2413 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2414 @end deffn
2415
2416 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2417 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2418 or v2 (USB bulk).
2419
2420 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2421 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2422 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2423 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2424 @example
2425 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2426 @end example
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2430 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2431
2432 @itemize @minus
2433 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2434 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2435 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2436 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2437 @end itemize
2438 @end deffn
2439
2440 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2441 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2442 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2443 interface string or for user class interface.
2444 @end deffn
2445
2446 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2447 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2448 @end deffn
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2452 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2453 @end deffn
2454
2455 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2456 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2457 @end deffn
2458
2459 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2460 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2461 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2462
2463 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2464 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2465
2466 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2467 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2468
2469 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2470 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2471 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2472 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2473 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2474 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2475
2476 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2477 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2478 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2479 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2480 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2481
2482 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2483 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2484 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2485 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2486
2487 @itemize @minus
2488 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2489 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2490 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2491 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2492 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2493 switching data and direction as necessary
2494 @end itemize
2495
2496 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2497 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2498
2499 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2500 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2501 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2502 @example
2503 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2504 @end example
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2508 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2509 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2510 during device selection.
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2514 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2515 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2519 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2520 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2521 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2522 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2523 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2524 and initially asserted reset signals.
2525 @end deffn
2526
2527 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2528 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2529 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2530 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2531 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2532 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2533 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2534 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2535 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2536 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2537 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2538
2539 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2540 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2541 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2542 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2543 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2544 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2545
2546 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2547 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2548 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2549 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2550 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2551 are always driven by the FTDI.
2552
2553 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2554 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2555 @var{name}.
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2559 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2560 @itemize @minus
2561 @item @option{0}, drive low
2562 @item @option{1}, drive high
2563 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2564 @end itemize
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2568 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2572 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2573
2574 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2575 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2576 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2577 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2578 @itemize @minus
2579 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2580 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2581 @end itemize
2582 @end deffn
2583
2584 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2585 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2586
2587 @end deffn
2588
2589 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2590 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2591 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2592 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2593
2594 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2595 @itemize @minus
2596 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2597 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2598 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2599 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2600 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2601 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2602 @end itemize
2603
2604 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2605 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2606 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2607 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2608 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2609 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2610 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2611 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2612
2613 FT232R
2614 @itemize @minus
2615 @item bit 7 - RI
2616 @item bit 6 - DCD
2617 @item bit 5 - DSR
2618 @item bit 4 - DTR
2619 @item bit 3 - CTS
2620 @item bit 2 - RTS
2621 @item bit 1 - RXD
2622 @item bit 0 - TXD
2623 @end itemize
2624
2625 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2626 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2627
2628 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2629 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2630 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2634 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2635 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2639 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2640 @end deffn
2641
2642 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2643 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2647 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2651 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2655 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2659 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2663 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2664 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2665 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2666 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2667 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2668 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2669 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2670 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2671 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2677 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2678 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2679 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2680
2681 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2682 processors which are being simulated.
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2685 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2686 sockets instead of TCP.
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2690 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2691 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2695 something like:
2696
2697 @example
2698 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2699 remote_bitbang port 3335
2700 remote_bitbang host foobar
2701 @end example
2702
2703 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2704 named mysocket:
2705
2706 @example
2707 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2708 remote_bitbang port 0
2709 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2710 @end example
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2714 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2715 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2716 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2717
2718 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2719 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2720 default values are used.
2721 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2722 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2723 @example
2724 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2725 @end example
2726 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2727 @example
2728 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2729 @end example
2730 @end deffn
2731
2732 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2733 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2734 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2735 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2736 target board.
2737
2738 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2739 @example
2740 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2741 reset_config srst_only
2742 @end example
2743 @end deffn
2744
2745 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2746 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2747 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2748 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2749 @end deffn
2750
2751 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2752 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2753 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2754 @end deffn
2755
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2759 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2760 This has one driver-specific command:
2761
2762 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2763 Display either the address of the I/O port
2764 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2765 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2766 This is a write-once setting.
2767 @end deffn
2768 @end deffn
2769
2770 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2771 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2772 transports.
2773
2774 @quotation Compatibility Note
2775 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2776 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2777 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2778 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2779 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2780 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2781 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2782 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2783 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2784 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2785 @end quotation
2786
2787 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2788 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2789 states.
2790 @end deffn
2791 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2792 Display free device internal memory.
2793 @end deffn
2794 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2795 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2796 command version.
2797 @end deffn
2798 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2799 Display the device configuration.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2802 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2803 power state.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2806 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2807 @end deffn
2808 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2809 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2810 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2811 IP configuration.
2812 @end deffn
2813 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2814 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2815 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2816 @end deffn
2817 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2818 Reset the current configuration.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2821 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2822 @end deffn
2823 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2824 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2825 pairs.
2826
2827 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2828 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2829 @example
2830 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2831 @end example
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2834 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2835 pairs.
2836
2837 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2838 @example
2839 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2840 77a90000
2841 @end example
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2844 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2845 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2846 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2847 the serial number instead, if possible.
2848
2849 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2850 @end deffn
2851 @end deffn
2852
2853 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2854 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2855 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2856 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2857 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2858 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2859 configuration script.
2860
2861 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2862 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2863 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2864 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2865 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2866
2867 Known limitations:
2868 @itemize @bullet
2869 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2870 and 2.7 MHz.
2871 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2872 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2873 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2874 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2875 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2876 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2877 communications with the target.
2878 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2879 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2880 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2881 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2882 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2883 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2884 @end itemize
2885
2886 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2887 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2888 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2889 @end deffn
2890
2891 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2892 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2893 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2894 target as a side-effect.
2895 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2896 @end deffn
2897
2898 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2899 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2900 version, and target voltage.
2901 @end deffn
2902 @end deffn
2903
2904 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2905 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2906 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2907 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2908 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2911 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2912 This is a write-once setting.
2913 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2914
2915 @itemize @minus
2916 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2917 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2918 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2919 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2920 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2921 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2922 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2923 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2924 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2925 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2926 some versions of
2927 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2928 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2929 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2930 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2931 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2932 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2933 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2934 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2935 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2936 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2937 @end itemize
2938 @end deffn
2939
2940 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2941 Display either the address of the I/O port
2942 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2943 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2944 This is a write-once setting.
2945
2946 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2947 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2948 you may encounter a problem.
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2952 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2953 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2954 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2955 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2956 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2957
2958 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2959 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2960 @quotation Tip
2961 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2962 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2963 @example
2964 > parport toggling_time 1000
2965 > adapter speed 500
2966 @end example
2967 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2968 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2969 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2970 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2971 large set of samples.
2972 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2973 @example
2974 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2975 @end example
2976 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2977 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2978
2979 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2980 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2981 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2982 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2983 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2984 be conservative.
2985 @end quotation
2986 @end deffn
2987
2988 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2989 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2990 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2991 @end deffn
2992
2993 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2994 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2995
2996 @example
2997 adapter driver parport
2998 parport port 0x278
2999 parport cable wiggler
3000 @end example
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3004 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3005 @end deffn
3006
3007 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3008 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3009 @end deffn
3010
3011 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3012 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3013 @end deffn
3014
3015 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3016 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3017
3018 @quotation Note
3019 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3020 which are not currently documented here.
3021 @end quotation
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @anchor{hla_interface}
3025 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3026 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3027 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3028 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3029
3030 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3031 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3032 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3033 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3034 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3035 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3036
3037 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3038 Currently Not Supported.
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3042 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3046 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3047 @end deffn
3048
3049 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3050 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3051 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3052
3053 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3054 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3055 ST-LINK server software module}.
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3059 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3060 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3061 @end deffn
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3065 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3066 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3067 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3068 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3069
3070 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3071 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3072 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3073 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3074
3075 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3076 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3077
3078 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3079 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3080 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3081
3082 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3083 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3084 ST-LINK server software module}.
3085
3086 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3090 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3094 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3095 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3096
3097 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3098 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3099 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3100 the target's supply voltage.
3101 @example
3102 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3103 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3104 @end example
3105 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3106 @example
3107 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3108 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3109 3.24891518738
3110 @end example
3111 @end deffn
3112 @end deffn
3113
3114 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3115 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3119 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3123 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3124 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3125 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3126 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3127
3128 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3129 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3130 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3131 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3135 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3136 version).
3137 @end deffn
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3141 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3142 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3143 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3144 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3145
3146 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3147
3148 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3149 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3150
3151 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3152 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3153
3154 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3155
3156 @end deffn
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3160 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3161 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3162
3163 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3164 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3165 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3166 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3167 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3168 configuration on exit.
3169
3170 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3171
3172 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3173 pinout.
3174
3175 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3176 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3177 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3178 individually.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3182 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3183 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3187 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3188 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3189 @end deffn
3190
3191 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3192 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3193 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3194 @end deffn
3195
3196 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3197 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3198 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3199 @end deffn
3200
3201 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3202 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3203 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3207 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3208 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3212 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3213 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3217 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3218 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3219 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3223 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3227 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3228 @end deffn
3229
3230 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3231 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3232 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3233 @end deffn
3234
3235 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3236 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3237 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3238 list can be found in the
3239 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242 @end deffn
3243
3244 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3245 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3246 of the one which is most popular.
3247
3248 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3249
3250 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3251 pinout.
3252
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255
3256 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3257 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3258 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3259
3260 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3261 @end deffn
3262
3263
3264 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3265 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3266 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3267
3268 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3269 @end deffn
3270
3271
3272 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3273 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3274 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3275
3276 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3277 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3278 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3279
3280 @itemize @minus
3281 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3282 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3283 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3284 @end itemize
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3288 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3289 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3290 @end deffn
3291 @end deffn
3292
3293
3294 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3295 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3296 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3297 DPI server interface.
3298
3299 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3300 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3304 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3305 @end deffn
3306 @end deffn
3307
3308
3309 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3310
3311 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3312 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3313
3314 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3315 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3316
3317 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3318 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3319 @example
3320 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3321 @end example
3322 @end deffn
3323
3324 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3325 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3326 @example
3327 buspirate speed normal
3328 @end example
3329 @end deffn
3330
3331 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3332 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3333 @itemize @minus
3334 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3335 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3336 @end itemize
3337 For example:
3338 @example
3339 buspirate mode normal
3340 @end example
3341 @end deffn
3342
3343 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3344 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3345 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3346 For example:
3347 @example
3348 buspirate pullup 0
3349 @end example
3350 @end deffn
3351
3352 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3353 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3354 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3355 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3356 @example
3357 buspirate vreg 0
3358 @end example
3359 @end deffn
3360
3361 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3362 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3363 @end deffn
3364 @example
3365 buspirate led 1
3366 @end example
3367
3368 @end deffn
3369
3370
3371 @section Transport Configuration
3372 @cindex Transport
3373 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3374 and the debug adapter you are using,
3375 several transports may be available to
3376 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3377 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3378 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3379 version of OpenOCD.
3380 @end deffn
3381
3382 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3383 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3384
3385 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3386 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3387 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3388 adapter's driver).
3389
3390 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3391 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3392 supported by the debug adapter.
3393
3394 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3395 transport, if any.
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398 @subsection JTAG Transport
3399 @cindex JTAG
3400 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3401 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3402 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3403 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3404 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3405 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3406
3407 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3408 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3409 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3410 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3411 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3412
3413 @subsection SWD Transport
3414 @cindex SWD
3415 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3416 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3417 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3418 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3419 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3420 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3421 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3422
3423 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3424 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3425 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3426 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3427 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3428
3429 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3430 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3431 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3432 expected to change.
3433 @end deffn
3434
3435 @subsection SPI Transport
3436 @cindex SPI
3437 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3438 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3439 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3440 solution for flash programming.
3441
3442 @anchor{swimtransport}
3443 @subsection SWIM Transport
3444 @cindex SWIM
3445 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3446 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3447 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3448 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3449
3450 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3451
3452 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3453
3454 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3455 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3456 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3457 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3458 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3459
3460 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3461 @section JTAG Speed
3462 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3463 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3464 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3465 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3466 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3467 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3468 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3469 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3470 power management software that may be active.
3471
3472 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3473 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3474 target event handler.
3475 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3476 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3477 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3478 sets up those clocks).
3479 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3480 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3481 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3482 in the target config file.
3483 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3484 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3485 config file instead.
3486 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3487 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3488 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3489
3490 @example
3491 jtag_rclk 3000
3492 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3493 @end example
3494
3495 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3496 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3497 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3498 may not be the fastest solution.
3499
3500 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3501 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3502 which support adaptive clocking.
3503
3504 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3505 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3506 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3507 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3508 than the speed specified.
3509
3510 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3511 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3512 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3513 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3514
3515 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3516 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3517 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3518 JTAG clocking after setup.
3519 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3520 If the interface device can not
3521 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3522 @end deffn
3523
3524 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3525 @cindex adaptive clocking
3526 @cindex RTCK
3527 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3528 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3529 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3530 @example
3531 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3532 jtag_rclk 3000
3533 @end example
3534 @end defun
3535
3536 @node Reset Configuration
3537 @chapter Reset Configuration
3538 @cindex Reset Configuration
3539
3540 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3541 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3542 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3543 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3544 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3545 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3546 Please see the various board files for examples.
3547
3548 @quotation Note
3549 To maintainers and integrators:
3550 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3551 Normally the board configuration file
3552 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3553 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3554
3555 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3556 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3557 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3558 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3559 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3560 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3561 @end quotation
3562
3563 @section Types of Reset
3564
3565 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3566 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3567 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3568
3569 @itemize @bullet
3570 @item
3571 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3572 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3573 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3574 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3575 @item
3576 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3577 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3578 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3579 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3580 @item
3581 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3582 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3583 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3584 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3585 @item
3586 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3587 several other types of reset.
3588 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3589 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3590 There may be individual module resets.
3591 @end itemize
3592
3593 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3594 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3595 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3596 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3597 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3598 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3599 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3600 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3601 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3602
3603 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3604 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3605
3606 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3607 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3608 common issues are:
3609
3610 @itemize @bullet
3611
3612 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3613 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3614 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3615 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3616 when either of those signals is not connected.
3617 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3618 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3619 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3620 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3621
3622 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3623 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3624 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3625 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3626
3627 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3628 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3629 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3630 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3631 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3632 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3633 hardware debouncing.
3634 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3635 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3636
3637 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3638 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3639 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3640 to use push/pull output drivers.
3641 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3642 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3643 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3644 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3645
3646 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3647 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3648 issues (not limited to errata).
3649 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3650 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3651 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3652 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3653 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3654 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3655 @end itemize
3656
3657 There can also be other issues.
3658 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3659 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3660 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3661 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3662 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3663 Agreement (NDA).
3664
3665 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3666 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3667 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3668
3669 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3670 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3671
3672 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3673
3674 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3675 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3676 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3677 allowing it to be deasserted.
3678 @end deffn
3679
3680 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3681 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3682 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3683 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3684 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3685 @end deffn
3686
3687 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3688 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3689 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3690 allowing it to be deasserted.
3691 @end deffn
3692
3693 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3694 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3695 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3696 @end deffn
3697
3698 @anchor{reset_config}
3699 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3700 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3701 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3702 configuration scripts.
3703
3704 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3705 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3706 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3707 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3708 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3709 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3710 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3711 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3712
3713 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3714 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3715 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3716 -- may be specified at a time.
3717 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3718 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3719 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3720 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3721 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3722
3723 @itemize
3724 @item
3725 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3726 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3727 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3728 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3729 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3730
3731 @quotation Tip
3732 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3733 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3734 @end quotation
3735
3736 @item
3737 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3738 signal implementations.
3739 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3740 indicating everything behaves normally.
3741 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3742 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3743 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3744 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3745 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3746 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3747 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3748
3749 @item
3750 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3751 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3752 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3753 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3754 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3755 while SRST is asserted.
3756 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3757 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3758
3759 @item
3760 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3761 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3762 is required to use this option.
3763 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3764 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3765 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3766 be asserted before any target connection.
3767 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3768 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3769 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3770 @end itemize
3771
3772 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3773 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3774 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3775 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3776 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3777
3778 @itemize
3779 @item
3780 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3781 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3782 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3783 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3784
3785 @item
3786 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3787 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3788 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3789 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3790 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3791 @end itemize
3792 @end deffn
3793
3794 @section Custom Reset Handling
3795 @cindex events
3796
3797 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3798 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3799 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3800 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3801 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3802 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3803
3804 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3805 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3806 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3807 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3808 want to reset everything at once.
3809
3810 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3811 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3812 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3813 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3814 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3815 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3816 needs special attention.
3817
3818 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3819 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3820 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3821 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3822 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3823 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3824 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3825 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3826 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3827
3828 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3829 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3830 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3831 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3832 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3833
3834 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3835 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3836 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3837 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3838 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3839 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3840 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3841 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3842 or potentially some other value.
3843
3844 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3845 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3846 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3847 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3848 (or their associated targets)
3849 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3850
3851 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3852 they return.
3853 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3854 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3855 @end deffn
3856
3857 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3858 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3859 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3860 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3861 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3862 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3863 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3864 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3865 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3866 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3867 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3868 @end deffn
3869
3870 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3871 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3872 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3873 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3874 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3875 @end deffn
3876
3877
3878 @node TAP Declaration
3879 @chapter TAP Declaration
3880 @cindex TAP declaration
3881 @cindex TAP configuration
3882
3883 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3884 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3885
3886 @itemize @bullet
3887 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3888 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3889 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3890 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3891 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3892 start running that code.
3893 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3894 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3895 and missing connections.
3896 @end itemize
3897
3898 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3899 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3900 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3901 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3902 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3903
3904 @section Scan Chains
3905 @cindex scan chain
3906
3907 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3908 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3909 They also need to be added to
3910 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3911 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3912 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3913 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3914 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3915 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3916 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3917 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3918
3919 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3920 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3921 command, presented in the next chapter.
3922 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3923 debugging targets.)
3924 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3925
3926 @verbatim
3927 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3928 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3929 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3930 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3931 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3932 @end verbatim
3933
3934 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3935 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3936 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3937 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3938 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3939 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3940 until they are told to do so.
3941
3942 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3943 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3944 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3945 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3946
3947 @example
3948 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3949 @end example
3950
3951 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3952 by a given chip.
3953 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3954 and so forth.
3955 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3956 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3957 both inside a single chip and between them.
3958 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3959
3960 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3961 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3962 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3963 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3964 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3965 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3966 includes commands something like this:
3967
3968 @example
3969 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3970 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3971 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3972 @end example
3973
3974 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3975 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3976 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3977
3978 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
3979 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3980 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3981 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3982 @example
3983 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3984 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3985 @}
3986 @end example
3987 @end deffn
3988
3989 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
3990 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3991 and their status.
3992 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3993 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3994 but systems with a JTAG router can
3995 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3996 @end deffn
3997
3998 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3999 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4000
4001 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4002 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4003
4004 @section TAP Names
4005 @cindex dotted name
4006
4007 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4008 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4009 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4010 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4011 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4012 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4013 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4014 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4015
4016 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4017 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4018 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4019
4020 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4021
4022 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4023 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4024 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4025
4026 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4027 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4028 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4029 overridable.
4030
4031 @cindex TAP naming convention
4032 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4033 and should follow this convention:
4034
4035 @itemize @bullet
4036 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4037 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4038 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4039 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4040 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4041 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4042 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4043 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4044 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4045 with a single TAP;
4046 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4047 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4048 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4049 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4050 @end itemize
4051
4052 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4053
4054 @itemize @bullet
4055 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4056 @*The length in bits of the
4057 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4058 @end itemize
4059
4060 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4061
4062 @itemize @bullet
4063 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4064 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4065 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4066 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4067 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4068 (the TAP is linked in).
4069 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4070 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4071 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4072 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4073 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4074 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4075 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4076 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4077 values that were found but not included in the list.
4078
4079 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4080 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4081 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4082 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4083 hardware to find these values.
4084 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4085 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4086 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4087 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4088 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4089 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4090 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4091 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4092 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4093 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4094 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4095 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4096 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4097 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4098 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4099 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4100 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4101 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4102 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4103 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4104 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4105 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4106 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4107 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4108 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4109 @end itemize
4110 @end deffn
4111
4112 @section Other TAP commands
4113
4114 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4115 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4116 @end deffn
4117
4118 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4119 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4120 At this writing this TAP attribute
4121 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4122 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4123 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4124 See the next section for information about the available events.
4125
4126 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4127 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4128 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4129 @end deffn
4130
4131 @section TAP Events
4132 @cindex events
4133 @cindex TAP events
4134
4135 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4136 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4137 The other applies to debugger targets,
4138 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4139
4140 The TAP events currently defined are:
4141
4142 @itemize @bullet
4143 @item @b{post-reset}
4144 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4145 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4146 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4147 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4148 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4149
4150 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4151 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4152 of any particular target.
4153 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4154 @item @b{setup}
4155 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4156 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4157 @item @b{tap-disable}
4158 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4159 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4160 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4161 @item @b{tap-enable}
4162 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4163 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4164 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4165 @end itemize
4166
4167 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4168 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4169 contents to be accurate), you might:
4170
4171 @example
4172 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4173 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4174 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4175 @}
4176 @end example
4177
4178
4179 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4180 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4181 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4182 @cindex jrc
4183
4184 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4185 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4186 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4187 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4188 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4189
4190 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4191 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4192 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4193 be visible.
4194 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4195 ignores, such as:
4196
4197 @itemize
4198 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4199 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4200 TAPs receive new instructions.
4201 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4202 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4203 @end itemize
4204
4205 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4206 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4207 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4208 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4209
4210 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4211 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4212
4213 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4214 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4215 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4216 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4217 should define TAP event handlers using
4218 code that looks something like this:
4219
4220 @example
4221 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4222 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4223 @}
4224 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4225 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4226 @}
4227 @end example
4228
4229 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4230
4231 @example
4232 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4233 @end example
4234
4235 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4236 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4237 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4238 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4239
4240 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4241 If necessary, disables the tap
4242 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4243 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4244 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4245 and "0" if it is disabled.
4246 @end deffn
4247
4248 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4249 If necessary, enables the tap
4250 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4251 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4252 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4253 and "0" if it is disabled.
4254 @end deffn
4255
4256 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4257 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4258 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4259 and "0" if it is disabled.
4260
4261 @quotation Note
4262 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4263 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4264 @end quotation
4265 @end deffn
4266
4267 @anchor{autoprobing}
4268 @section Autoprobing
4269 @cindex autoprobe
4270 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4271
4272 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4273 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4274 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4275 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4276
4277 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4278 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4279 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4280 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4281 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4282 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4283 right when they come out of reset).
4284
4285 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4286
4287 @example
4288 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4289 reset_config trst_and_srst
4290 jtag_rclk 8
4291 @end example
4292
4293 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4294 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4295
4296 @enumerate
4297 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4298 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4299 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4300 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4301 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4302 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4303 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4304 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4305 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4306 that is discovered.
4307 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4308 register, it will report it.
4309 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4310 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4311 @end enumerate
4312
4313 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4314 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4315 that's a bit more complex:
4316
4317 @example
4318 clock speed 8 kHz
4319 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4320 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4321 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4322 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4323 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4324 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4325 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4326 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4327 @end example
4328
4329 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4330 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4331 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4332 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4333 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4334 and so forth.
4335
4336 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4337 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4338 @cindex DAP declaration
4339
4340 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4341 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4342 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4343 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4344 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4345
4346 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4347
4348 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4349 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4350 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4351 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4352 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4353
4354 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4355
4356 @itemize @bullet
4357 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4358 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4359 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4360 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4361 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4362
4363 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4364 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4365 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4366 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4367 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4368 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4369
4370 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4371 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4372 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4373 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4374 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4375 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4376 @end itemize
4377 @end deffn
4378
4379 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4380 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4381 for TCL scripting.
4382 @end deffn
4383
4384 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4385 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4386 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4390 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4391 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4392 initialization, too.
4393 @end deffn
4394
4395 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4396
4397 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4398 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4399 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4400 @end deffn
4401
4402 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4403 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4404 @end deffn
4405
4406 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4407 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4408 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4409 or set a new value @var{value}.
4410 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4411 @end deffn
4412
4413 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4414 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4415 @end deffn
4416
4417 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4418 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4419 value @var{value}.
4420
4421 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4422 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4423 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4424
4425 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4426 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4430 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4431 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4432 @end deffn
4433
4434 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4435 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4436 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4437 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4438 @end deffn
4439
4440 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4441 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4442
4443 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4444 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4445 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4446 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4447 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4448 for details.
4449
4450 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4451 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4452 the pattern:
4453 @example
4454 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4455 @end example
4456
4457 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4458 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4459 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4460 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4461 @example
4462 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4463 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4464 @end example
4465
4466 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4467 @example
4468 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4469 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4470 @end example
4471
4472 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4473 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4474
4475 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4476 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4477 example with a proper dap name:
4478 @example
4479 xxx.dap apcsw default
4480 @end example
4481 @end deffn
4482
4483 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4484 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4485 Disabled by default
4486 @end deffn
4487
4488
4489 @node CPU Configuration
4490 @chapter CPU Configuration
4491 @cindex GDB target
4492
4493 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4494 You can also access these targets without GDB
4495 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4496 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4497 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4498 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4499
4500 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4501 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4502
4503 @section Target List
4504 @cindex target, current
4505 @cindex target, list
4506
4507 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4508 where each member has a name.
4509 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4510 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4511 (plural!) command.
4512 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4513 look like with more than one:
4514 @verbatim
4515 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4516 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4517 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4518 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4519 @end verbatim
4520
4521 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4522 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4523 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4524 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4525 space seen by that current target.
4526 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4527 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4528 are examples; and there are many more.
4529
4530 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4531
4532 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4533 Returns the name of the current target.
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4537 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4538 @example
4539 foreach t [target names] @{
4540 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4541 @}
4542 @end example
4543 @end deffn
4544
4545 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4546 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4547
4548 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4549 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4550 command names are singular.}
4551
4552 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4553 targets in a user friendly form.
4554
4555 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4556 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4557 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4558 @end deffn
4559
4560 @section Target CPU Types
4561 @cindex target type
4562 @cindex CPU type
4563
4564 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4565 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4566 when calling @command{target create}.
4567 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4568 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4569 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4570 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4571 what core-specific commands may be available
4572 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4573 and more.
4574
4575 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4576 since there's a command to list them.
4577
4578 @anchor{targettypes}
4579 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4580 Lists all supported target types.
4581 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4582
4583 @itemize @bullet
4584 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4585 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4586 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4587 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4588 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4589 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4590 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4591 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4592 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4593 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4594 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4595 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4596 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4597 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4598 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4599 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4600 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4601 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4602 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4603 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4604 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4605 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4606 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4607 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4608 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4609 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4610 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4611 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4612 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4613 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4614 support for new CPUs.
4615 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4616 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4617 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4618 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4619 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4620 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4621 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4622 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4623 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4624 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4625 @itemize @minus
4626 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4627 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4628 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4629 @end itemize
4630 And two debug interfaces cores:
4631 @itemize @minus
4632 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4633 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4634 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4635 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4636 @end itemize
4637 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4638 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4639 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4640 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4641 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4642 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4643 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4644 @end itemize
4645 @end deffn
4646
4647 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4648 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4649 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4650 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4651 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4652 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4653 reflect design generations;
4654 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4655 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4656
4657 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4658 @section Target Configuration
4659
4660 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4661 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4662 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4663 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4664 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4665
4666 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4667 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4668 optional parts.
4669 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4670 command, created as part of target creation.
4671
4672 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4673 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4674 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4675 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4676 to be much more board-specific.
4677 The key steps you use might look something like this
4678
4679 @example
4680 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4681 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4682 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4683 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4684 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4685 @end example
4686
4687 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4688 on-chip SRAM.
4689 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4690 writes to target memory;
4691 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4692 GDB memory checksumming;
4693 and more.
4694
4695 @quotation Warning
4696 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4697 inaccessible when application code
4698 (such as an operating system)
4699 enables or disables the MMU.
4700 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4701 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4702 easy access to other addresses needed.
4703 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4704 @end quotation
4705
4706 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4707 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4708 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4709 controllers.
4710 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4711 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4712 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4713
4714 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4715 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4716 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4717 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4718 purposes including additional configuration.
4719
4720 @itemize @bullet
4721 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4722 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4723 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4724 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4725
4726 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4727 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4728 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4729 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4730 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4731 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4732 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4733
4734 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4735 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4736 @end itemize
4737 @end deffn
4738
4739 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4740 The options accepted by this command may also be
4741 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4742 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4743 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4744
4745 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4746 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4747 and changing its endianness.
4748
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750
4751 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4752 used to access this target.
4753
4754 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4755 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4756 create and manage DAP instances.
4757
4758 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4759 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4760
4761 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4762 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4763 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4764 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4765 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4766 same event name assigns only one handler.
4767
4768 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4769 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4770
4771 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4772 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4773 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4774 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4775 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4776 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4777 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4778
4779 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4780 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4781 or virtual address is being used.
4782
4783 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4784 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4785
4786 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4787 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4788 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4789 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4790 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4791
4792 @anchor{rtostype}
4793 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4794 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4795 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4796 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4797 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4798 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4799
4800 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4801 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4802 access the target for debugging.
4803
4804 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4805 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4806 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4807 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4808
4809 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4810 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4811 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4812 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4813 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4814
4815 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4816 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4817 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4818 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4819 command @command{gdb_port}.
4820 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4821
4822 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4823 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4824 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4825 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4826 @end itemize
4827 @end deffn
4828
4829 @section Other $target_name Commands
4830 @cindex object command
4831
4832 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4833 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4834
4835 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4836 Once a button is created a button
4837 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4838 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4839 configure it like this:
4840
4841 @example
4842 # Create
4843 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4844 # Modify
4845 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4846 # Query
4847 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4848 # Report
4849 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4850 @end example
4851
4852 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4853 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4854
4855 @example
4856 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4857 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4858 @end example
4859
4860 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4861
4862 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4863 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4864 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4865 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4866 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4867 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4868 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4869 They are not otherwise documented here.
4870 @end deffn
4871
4872 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4873 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4874 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4875 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4876 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4877 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4878 the target side uses raw memory.
4879
4880 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4881 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4882 The script orientation comes from working with data
4883 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4884 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4885 and neither store nor return those values.
4886
4887 @itemize
4888 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4889 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4890 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4891 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4892 @end itemize
4893 @end deffn
4894
4895 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4896 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4897 @command{$target_name configure}
4898 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4899 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4900 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4901 There are a few special cases:
4902
4903 @itemize @bullet
4904 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4905 event named @var{event_name}.
4906 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4907 two parameters.
4908 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4909 This is a special case because this is set using
4910 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4911 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4912 @end itemize
4913
4914 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4915 all the targets you might use something like this:
4916
4917 @example
4918 foreach name [target names] @{
4919 set y [$name cget -endian]
4920 set z [$name cget -type]
4921 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4922 $x $name $y $z]
4923 @}
4924 @end example
4925 @end deffn
4926
4927 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4928 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4929 Displays the current target state:
4930 @code{debug-running},
4931 @code{halted},
4932 @code{reset},
4933 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4934 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4935 @end deffn
4936
4937 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4938 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4939 currently associated with this target.
4940 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4941 @end deffn
4942
4943 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4944 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4945 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4946 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4947 @end deffn
4948
4949 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4950 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4951 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4952 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4953 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4954 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4955 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4956 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4957 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4958 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4959 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4960 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4961 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4962 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4963 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4964 @end deffn
4965
4966 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4967 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4968 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4969 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4970 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4971 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4972 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4973 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4974 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4975 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4976 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4977 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4978 @end deffn
4979
4980 @anchor{targetevents}
4981 @section Target Events
4982 @cindex target events
4983 @cindex events
4984 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4985 For example:
4986 @itemize @bullet
4987 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4988 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4989 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4990 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4991 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4992 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4993 to set up system clocks or
4994 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4995 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4996 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4997 @end itemize
4998
4999 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5000 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5001 @command{target create ... -event}.
5002
5003 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5004 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5005 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5006
5007 @example
5008 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5009 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5010 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5011 @}
5012 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5013 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5014 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5015 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5016 @}
5017 @end example
5018
5019 The following target events are defined:
5020
5021 @itemize @bullet
5022 @item @b{debug-halted}
5023 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5024 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5025 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5026 @item @b{early-halted}
5027 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5028 @item @b{examine-start}
5029 @* Before target examine is called.
5030 @item @b{examine-end}
5031 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5032 @item @b{examine-fail}
5033 @* After target examine fails.
5034 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5035 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5036 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5037 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5038 connect GDB to running target.
5039 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5040 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5041 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5042 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5043 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5044 is in RAM or read only memory.
5045 Default is @code{halt}
5046 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5047 @* When GDB disconnects
5048 @item @b{gdb-end}
5049 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5050 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5051 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5052 @code{reset init})
5053 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5054 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5055 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5056 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5057 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5058 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5059 @item @b{gdb-start}
5060 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5061 @item @b{halted}
5062 @* The target has halted
5063 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5064 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5065 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5066 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5067 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5068 @item @b{reset-assert}
5069 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5070 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5071 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5072 it instead of asserting SRST.
5073 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5074 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5075 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5076 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5077 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5078 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5079 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5080 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5081 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5082 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5083 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5084 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5085 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5086 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5087 released on the scan chain.
5088 @item @b{reset-end}
5089 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5090 @item @b{reset-init}
5091 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5092 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5093
5094 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5095 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5096 multiplexing, and so on.
5097 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5098 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5099 @item @b{reset-start}
5100 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5101 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5102
5103 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5104 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5105 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5106 @item @b{resume-start}
5107 @* Before any target is resumed
5108 @item @b{resume-end}
5109 @* After all targets have resumed
5110 @item @b{resumed}
5111 @* Target has resumed
5112 @item @b{step-start}
5113 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5114 @item @b{step-end}
5115 @* After single-step has completed
5116 @item @b{trace-config}
5117 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5118 @end itemize
5119
5120 @quotation Note
5121 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5122 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5123 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5124 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5125 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5126 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5127 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5128 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5129 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5130 check if the core has changed status.
5131 @end quotation
5132
5133 @node Flash Commands
5134 @chapter Flash Commands
5135
5136 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5137 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5138 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5139 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5140 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5141 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5142 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5143 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5144 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5145
5146 Flash Steps:
5147 @enumerate
5148 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5149 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5150 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5151 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5152 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5153 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5154 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5155 @item GDB Flashing
5156 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5157 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5158 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5159 @end enumerate
5160
5161 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5162 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5163 so that it can't boot.
5164 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5165 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5166
5167 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5168 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5169 @cindex flash configuration
5170
5171 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5172 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5173 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5174 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5175 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5176 see the driver-specific documentation.
5177
5178 @itemize @bullet
5179 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5180 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5181 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5182 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5183 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5184 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5185 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5186 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5187 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5188 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5189 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5190 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5191 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5192 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5193 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5194 commands to the flash controller.
5195 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5196 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5197 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5198 for more information.
5199 @end itemize
5200 @quotation Note
5201 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5202 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5203 @end quotation
5204 @end deffn
5205
5206 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5207 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5208 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5209 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5210 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5211 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5212 @end deffn
5213
5214 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5215 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5216 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5217 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5221 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5222 depends on the flash type.
5223 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5224 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5225 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5226 but most don't bother.
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5230
5231 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5232 begins.
5233
5234 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5235 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5236 until the programming session is finished.
5237
5238 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5239 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5240
5241 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5242
5243 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5244 @cindex flash erasing
5245 @cindex flash reading
5246 @cindex flash writing
5247 @cindex flash programming
5248 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5249
5250 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5251 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5252 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5253 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5254 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5255
5256 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5257 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5258 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5259 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5260 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5261
5262 @quotation Note
5263 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5264 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5265 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5266 back to a flash bank.
5267 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5268 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5269 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5270 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5271 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5272 @end quotation
5273
5274 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5275 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5276 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5277 disabled first.
5278 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5279 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5280 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5281
5282 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5283 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5284 up to and including @var{last}.
5285 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5286 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5287 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5292 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5293 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5294 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5295 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5296 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5297 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5298 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5299 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5300 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5301 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5302 before erase starts.
5303 @end deffn
5304
5305 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5306 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5307 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5308 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5309 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5310 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5311 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5312 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5313 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5314 before issuing this command.
5315 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5316 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5317 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5318 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5319 @end deffn
5320 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5321
5322 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5323 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5324 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5325 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5326 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5327 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5328 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5329 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5330 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5331 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5332 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5333 @end deffn
5334
5335 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5336 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5337 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5338 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5339 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5340 @end deffn
5341
5342 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5343 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5344 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5345 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5346 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5347 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5348 @end deffn
5349
5350 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5351 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5352 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5353 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5354 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5355 @end deffn
5356
5357 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5358 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5359 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5360 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5361 to the base address for each section in the image.
5362 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5363 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5364 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5365 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5366 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5367 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5368 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5369 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5370 each image section.
5371
5372 @quotation Warning
5373 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5374 data you want to preserve.
5375 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5376 sections might be erased with no notice.
5377 @itemize
5378 @item
5379 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5380 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5381 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5382 @item
5383 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5384 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5385 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5386 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5387 @end itemize
5388 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5389 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5390 @end quotation
5391
5392 @end deffn
5393
5394 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5395 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5396 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5397 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5398 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5399 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5400 ordinary memory reads.
5401 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5402 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5403 check for successful programming.
5404 @end deffn
5405
5406 @section Other Flash commands
5407 @cindex flash protection
5408
5409 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5410 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5411 and display that status.
5412 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5413 @end deffn
5414
5415 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5416 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5417 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5418
5419 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5420 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5421 and possibly stale information.
5422 @end deffn
5423
5424 @anchor{flashprotect}
5425 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5426 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5427 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5428 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5429 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5430 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5431 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5432 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5433 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5434 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5435 @end deffn
5436
5437 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5438 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5439 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5440 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5441 @end deffn
5442
5443 @anchor{program}
5444 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5445 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5446 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5447 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5448 @end deffn
5449
5450 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5451 @section Flash Driver List
5452 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5453 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5454 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5455
5456 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5457 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5458 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5459
5460 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5461
5462 @itemize
5463 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5464 @end itemize
5465
5466 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5467 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5468 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5469 @example
5470 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5471 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5472 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5473 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5474 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5475 @end example
5476 @end deffn
5477
5478 @subsection External Flash
5479
5480 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5481 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5482 @cindex CFI
5483 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5484 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5485 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5486 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5487 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5488 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5489 configure a bus and its timings), or
5490 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5491 on the flash chip.
5492 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5493 speed up operation.
5494
5495 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5496
5497 @itemize
5498 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5499 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5500 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5501 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5502 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5503 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5504 @end itemize
5505
5506 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5507 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5508
5509 @example
5510 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5511 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5512 @end example
5513
5514 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5515 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5516 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5517
5518 @example
5519 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5520 @end example
5521
5522 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5523 @end deffn
5524
5525 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5526 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5527 @cindex SPI
5528 @cindex jtagspi
5529 @cindex bscan_spi
5530 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5531 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5532 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5533 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5534 accessed through JTAG.
5535
5536 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5537 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5538 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5539 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5540 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5541 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5542
5543 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5544 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5545 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5546 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5547 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5548 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5549 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5550 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5551
5552 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5553 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5554 command, see below.
5555
5556 @itemize
5557 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5558 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5559 @var{USER1} instruction.
5560 @end itemize
5561
5562 @example
5563 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5564 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5566 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5567 @end example
5568
5569 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5570 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5571 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5572 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5573 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5574 @example
5575 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5576 @end example
5577 @end deffn
5578
5579 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5580 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5581 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5582 @example
5583 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5584 @end example
5585 @end deffn
5586
5587 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5588 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5589 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5590 @end deffn
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5594 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5595 @cindex xcf
5596 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5597 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5598 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5599 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5600 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5601
5602 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5603 command accepts additional parameters:
5604 @itemize
5605 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5606 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5607 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5608 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5609 in master mode.
5610 @end itemize
5611 @example
5612 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5613 @end example
5614 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5615 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5616 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5617 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5618 dedicated sector.
5619 @end deffn
5620
5621 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5622 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5623 button.
5624 @example
5625 xcf configure 0
5626 @end example
5627 @end deffn
5628
5629 Additional driver notes:
5630 @itemize
5631 @item Only single revision supported.
5632 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5633 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5634 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5635 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5636 @end itemize
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5640 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5641 @cindex SPIFI
5642 @cindex lpcspifi
5643 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5644 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5645 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5646
5647 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5648 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5649 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5650 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5651 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5652
5653 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5654 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5655 are configured by the driver.
5656
5657 @example
5658 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5659 @end example
5660
5661 @end deffn
5662
5663 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5664 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5665 @cindex SMI
5666 @cindex stmsmi
5667 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5668 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5669 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5670 SPI flash devices.
5671 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5672 flash devices can be connected.
5673
5674 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5675 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5676 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5677 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5678 the flash content.
5679
5680 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5681 to identify the memory bank.
5682 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5683 flash size, are detected automatically.
5684
5685 @example
5686 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5687 @end example
5688
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5692 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5693 @cindex QuadSPI
5694 @cindex OctoSPI
5695 @cindex stmqspi
5696 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5697 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5698 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5699 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5700 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5701 mode is not.
5702
5703 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5704 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5705 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5706 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5707
5708 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5709 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5710 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5711
5712 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5713 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5714 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5715 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5716 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5717 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5718
5719 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5720 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5721 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5722 should be avoided.
5723
5724 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5725 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5726 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5727 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5728 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5729 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5730
5731 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5732 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5733 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5734 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5735 persist across openocd invocations.
5736
5737 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5738 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5739 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5740 required (see 'set' command).
5741
5742 @example
5743 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5744 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5746 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5747 @end example
5748
5749 There are three specific commands
5750 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5751 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5752 chip specific write protection engaged.
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5756 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5757 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5758 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5759 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5760 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5761
5762 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5763 which don't support an id command.
5764
5765 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5766 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5767 @end deffn
5768
5769 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5770 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5771 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5772 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5773 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5774
5775 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5776 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5777 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5778 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5779
5780 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5781
5782 To check basic communication settings, issue
5783 @example
5784 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5785 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5786 @end example
5787 for single flash mode or
5788 @example
5789 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5790 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5791 @end example
5792 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5793
5794 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5795 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5796 need a dummy address, e.g.
5797 @example
5798 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5799 @end example
5800 should return the status register contents.
5801
5802 @end deffn
5803
5804 @end deffn
5805
5806 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5807 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5808 Microcontroller platform.
5809
5810 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5811 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5812
5813 @example
5814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5815 @end example
5816
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5820 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5821 @cindex ath79
5822 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5823 chip selects.
5824 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5825 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5826 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5827 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5828 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5829 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5830
5831 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5832 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5833 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5834 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5835 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5836 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5837 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5838 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5839 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5840 with the default CS0.
5841 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5842 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5843 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5844
5845 @example
5846 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5847
5848 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5849 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5850 # distinguish the banks.
5851 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5852 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5853 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5854 @end example
5855
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5859 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5860 @cindex fespi
5861
5862 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5863
5864 @example
5865 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5866 @end example
5867 @end deffn
5868
5869 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5870
5871 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5872 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5873 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5874 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5875 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5876 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5877
5878 @example
5879 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5880 @end example
5881 @end deffn
5882
5883 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5884 @cindex ambiqmicro
5885 @cindex apollo
5886 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5887 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5888 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5889 with the target using SWD.
5890
5891 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5892 the device class of the MCU.
5893 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5894 to set up the flash banks.
5895 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5896 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5897
5898 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5899 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5900 and the second bank starts after the first.
5901
5902 @example
5903 # Flash bank 0
5904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5905 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5907 $_TARGETNAME
5908 @end example
5909
5910 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5911 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5912 are available to the user.
5913
5914 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5915
5916 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5917 Erase entire bank.
5918 @end deffn
5919 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5920 Erase device pages.
5921 @end deffn
5922 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5923 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5924 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5925 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5926 the flash.
5927 @end deffn
5928 @end deffn
5929
5930 @anchor{at91samd}
5931 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5932 @cindex at91samd
5933 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5934 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5935
5936 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5937
5938 The devices have one flash bank:
5939
5940 @example
5941 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5942 @end example
5943
5944 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5945 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5946 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5947 processor to be halted.
5948 @end deffn
5949
5950 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5951 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5952 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5953 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5954 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5955 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5956
5957 @example
5958 at91samd set-security enable
5959 @end example
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5963 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5964 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5965 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5966 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5967 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5968 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5969 in order to disable this feature.
5970
5971 @example
5972 at91samd eeprom
5973 at91samd eeprom 1024
5974 @end example
5975 @end deffn
5976
5977 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
5978 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5979 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5980 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5981 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5982 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5983
5984 @example
5985 at91samd bootloader
5986 at91samd bootloader 16384
5987 @end example
5988 @end deffn
5989
5990 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5991 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5992 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5993 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5997 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5998 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5999 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6000 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6001 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6002 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6003 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6004
6005 @example
6006 # Read user row
6007 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6008 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6009 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6010 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6011 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6012 # byte unchanged
6013 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6014 @end example
6015 @end deffn
6016
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @anchor{at91sam3}
6020 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6021 @cindex at91sam3
6022 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6023 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6024 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6025 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6026 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6027 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6028 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6029 chips are confirmed.}
6030
6031 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6032 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6033 the following fixed locations:
6034
6035 @example
6036 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6037 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6038 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6039 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6040 @end example
6041
6042 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6043 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6044 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6045
6046 @itemize
6047 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6048 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6049 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6050 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6051 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6052 @end itemize
6053
6054 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6055
6056 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6057 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6058 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6059 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6060 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6061 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6062 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6063
6064 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6065 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6066 @end deffn
6067
6068 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6069 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6070 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6071 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6072 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6073 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6074 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6075 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6076 @end deffn
6077
6078 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6079 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6080 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6081 @end deffn
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6085 @cindex at91sam4
6086 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6087 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6088 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6089 @end deffn
6090
6091 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6092 @cindex at91sam4l
6093 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6094 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6095 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6096
6097 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6098 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6099 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6100 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6101 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6102 @end deffn
6103 @end deffn
6104
6105 @anchor{atsame5}
6106 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6107 @cindex atsame5
6108 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6109 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6110 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6111
6112 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6113 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6114 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6115
6116 @example
6117 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6118 @end example
6119
6120 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6121 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6122 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6123 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6124 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6125 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6126
6127 @example
6128 atsame5 bootloader
6129 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6130 @end example
6131 @end deffn
6132
6133 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6134 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6135 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6136 processor to be halted.
6137 @end deffn
6138
6139 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6140 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6141 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6142 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6146 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6147 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6148 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6149 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6150 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6151 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6152 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6153
6154 @example
6155 # Read
6156 >atsame5 userpage
6157 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6158 # Write
6159 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6160 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6161 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6162 # bytes)
6163 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6164 @end example
6165 @end deffn
6166
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6170 @cindex atsamv
6171 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6172 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6173 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6177 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6178 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6179 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6180 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6181
6182 @example
6183 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6184 @end example
6185
6186 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6187 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6188
6189 @itemize
6190 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6191 @item @var{banks}
6192 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6193 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6194 @item @var{pages_size}
6195 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6196 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6197 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6198 @end itemize
6199
6200 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6201 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6202 will be autoconfigured.
6203 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6204
6205 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6206 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6207 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6208 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6209 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6210
6211 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6212 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6213 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6214 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6215 are not truly general purpose).
6216 @quotation Note
6217 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6218 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6219 @end quotation
6220 @end deffn
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6224 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6225 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6226 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6227 @end deffn
6228
6229 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6230 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6231 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6232 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6233
6234 @example
6235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6236 @end example
6237
6238 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6239 each single sector one by one.
6240
6241 @example
6242 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6243 @end example
6244
6245 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6246 @end deffn
6247
6248 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6249 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6250 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6251 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6252 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6253 starts at address 0.
6254
6255 @example
6256 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6257 @end example
6258 @end deffn
6259
6260 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6261 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6262 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6263 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6264 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6265 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6266 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6267 and programming the serial flash.
6268
6269 @example
6270 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6271 @end example
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6275 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6276 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6277 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6278 autoconfigures itself.
6279 @example
6280 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6281 @end example
6282 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6283 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6284 this via the following command:
6285 @example
6286 efm32 debuglock num
6287 @end example
6288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6289 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6290 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6291 supported.}
6292 @end deffn
6293
6294 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6295 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6296 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6297 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6298 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6299 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6300
6301 @example
6302 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6303 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6304 @end example
6305
6306 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6307 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6308 @end deffn
6309
6310 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6311 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6312 is an uncommon operation.}
6313 @end deffn
6314 @end deffn
6315
6316 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6317 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6318 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6319 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6320 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6321 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6322 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6323
6324 @example
6325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6326 @end example
6327 @end deffn
6328
6329 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6330 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6331 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6332 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6333 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6334 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6335 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6336 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6337 characters) ignored.
6338
6339 @example
6340 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6341 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6342 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6343 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6344 @end example
6345 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6346 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6350 @cindex kinetis
6351 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6352 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6353 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6354 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6355 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6356 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6357
6358 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6359 @itemize
6360 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6361 @end itemize
6362
6363 @example
6364 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6365 @end example
6366
6367 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6368 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6369 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6370 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6374 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6375 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6376 set by 'flash protect' command.
6377 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6378 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6379 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6380 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6381 with the rest of a flash image.
6382 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6386 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6387 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6388 @end deffn
6389
6390 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6391 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6392 and examine-fail event.
6393 @end deffn
6394
6395 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6396 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6397 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6398 @end deffn
6399
6400 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6401 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6402 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6403 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6404 command completes.
6405 @end deffn
6406
6407 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6408 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6409 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6410 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6411 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6412
6413 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6414 Program Partition command.
6415
6416 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6417 Reset the device after partition setting.
6418
6419 Show partition size:
6420 @example
6421 kinetis nvm_partition info
6422 @end example
6423
6424 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6425 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6426 @example
6427 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6428 @end example
6429
6430 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6431 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6432 @example
6433 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6434 @end example
6435 @end deffn
6436
6437 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6438 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6439 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6443 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6444 Command disables watchdog timer.
6445 @end deffn
6446 @end deffn
6447
6448 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6449 @cindex kinetis_ke
6450 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6451 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6452 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6453 autoconfigures itself.
6454 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6455
6456 @example
6457 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6458 @end example
6459
6460 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6461 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6465 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6466 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6467 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6468 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6472 Command disables watchdog timer.
6473 @end deffn
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6477 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6478 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6479 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6480 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6481
6482 @quotation Note
6483 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6484 driver:
6485 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6486 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6487 @end quotation
6488
6489 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6490 which must appear in the following order:
6491
6492 @itemize
6493 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6494 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6495 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6496 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6497 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6498 LPC43x[2357])
6499 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6500 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6501 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6502 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6503 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6504 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6505 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6506 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6507 at which the core is running
6508 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6509 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6510 @quotation Note
6511 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6512 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6513 However, if you do provide it,
6514 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6515 @end quotation
6516 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6517 ROM IAP entry point.
6518 @end itemize
6519
6520 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6521
6522 @example
6523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6524 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6525 @end example
6526
6527 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6528 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6529 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6530 @end deffn
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6534 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6535 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6536 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6537 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6538 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6539
6540 @example
6541 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6542 @end example
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6546 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6547 from NXP.
6548
6549 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6550 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6551 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6552 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6553 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6554 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6555 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6556 you start the PLL.
6557
6558 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6559
6560 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6561 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6562 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6563
6564 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6565 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6566 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6567 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6568 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6569 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6570 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6571
6572 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6573 @example
6574 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6575 @end example
6576
6577 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6578 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6579 @code{flash banks} command.
6580
6581 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6582 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6583 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6584 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6585 a known signature.
6586 Example:
6587 @example
6588 lpc2900 signature 0
6589 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6590 @end example
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6594 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6595 saves it to a file in binary format.
6596 Example:
6597 @example
6598 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6599 @end example
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6603 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6604 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6605 command:
6606
6607 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6608 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6609 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6610 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6611
6612 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6613 Example:
6614 @example
6615 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6616 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6617 @end example
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6621 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6622 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6623 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6624 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6625 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6626 912 bytes.
6627 @quotation Attention
6628 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6629 @end quotation
6630 Example:
6631 @example
6632 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6633 @end example
6634 @end deffn
6635
6636 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6637 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6638 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6639 after the next power cycle.
6640 @quotation Attention
6641 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6642 @end quotation
6643 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6644 Example:
6645 @example
6646 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6647 flash info 0
6648 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6649 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6650 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6651 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6652 @end example
6653 @end deffn
6654
6655 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6656 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6657 effective after the next power cycle.
6658 @quotation Attention
6659 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6660 @end quotation
6661 Examples:
6662 @example
6663 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6664 @end example
6665 @end deffn
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6669 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6670 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6671 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6672
6673 @example
6674 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6675 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6676 @end example
6677
6678 @itemize @bullet
6679 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6680 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6681 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6682 @end itemize
6683
6684 Example usage:
6685 @example
6686 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6687 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6688 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6689 @} else @{
6690 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6691 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6692 @}
6693 @end example
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6697 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6698 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6699 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6700 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6701 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6702
6703 @example
6704 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6705 @end example
6706
6707 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6708 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6709 only the main program flash.
6710
6711 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6712 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6713 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6714 @end deffn
6715
6716 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6717 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6718 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6719 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6720
6721 To erase and program the BSL:
6722 @example
6723 msp432 bsl unlock
6724 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6725 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6726 msp432 bsl lock
6727 @end example
6728 @end deffn
6729 @end deffn
6730
6731 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6732 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6733 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6734 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6735 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6736 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6737 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6738 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6739 also have division into regions: main and info.
6740 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6741 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6742
6743 @example
6744 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6745 @end example
6746
6747 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6748
6749 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6750 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6751 @end deffn
6752
6753 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6754 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6755 @end deffn
6756
6757 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6758 Erase all userflash including info region.
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6762 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6763 @end deffn
6764
6765 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6766 Check sectors protect.
6767 @end deffn
6768
6769 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6770 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6774 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6778 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6779 @end deffn
6780
6781 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6782 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6786 Show information about flash driver.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6792 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6793 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6794 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6795 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6796
6797 @example
6798 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6799 @end example
6800 @end deffn
6801
6802 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6803 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6804 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6805 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6806 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6807
6808 @example
6809 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6810 @end example
6811
6812 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6813
6814 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6815 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6816 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6817 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6818 code.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6822 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6828 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6829 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6830
6831 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6832 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6833 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6834 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6835
6836 @example
6837 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6838 @end example
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6842 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6843 and integrate flash memory.
6844
6845 @example
6846 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6848 @end example
6849
6850 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6851 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6852 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6853 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6854 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6855 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6856 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6857 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6858 @end deffn
6859 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6860 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6861 This will remove any Code Protection.
6862 @end deffn
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6866 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6867 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6868 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6869 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6870
6871 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6872 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6873
6874 @example
6875 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6876 @end example
6877
6878 psoc4-specific commands
6879 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6880 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6881
6882 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6883 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6884
6885 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6886 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6887 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6888
6889 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6890 @end deffn
6891
6892 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6893 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6894
6895 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6896 @end deffn
6897 @end deffn
6898
6899 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6900 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6901 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6902 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6903 apart from the base address.
6904
6905 @example
6906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6907 @end example
6908
6909 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6910 @quotation Attention
6911 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6912 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6913 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6914 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6915 @end quotation
6916
6917 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6918
6919 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6920 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6921 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6922 @end deffn
6923 @end deffn
6924
6925 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6926 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6927 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6928 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6929 apart from the base address.
6930
6931 @example
6932 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6933 $_TARGETNAME
6934 @end example
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6938 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6939 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6940 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6941
6942 @example
6943 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6944 @end example
6945
6946 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6947
6948 @itemize
6949 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6950 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6951 @end itemize
6952
6953 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6954
6955 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6956 @quotation Attention
6957 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6958 after successful write.
6959 @end quotation
6960 @end deffn
6961
6962 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
6963 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6964 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6965 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6966
6967 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6968 @itemize @bullet
6969 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6970 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6971 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6972 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6973 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6974 row size: 512 bytes.
6975 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6976 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6977 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6978 operation will erase row automatically.
6979 @end itemize
6980
6981 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6982 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6983
6984 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6985
6986 @example
6987 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6988 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6989 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6990 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6991 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6992 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6993 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6994 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6995 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6996 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6997 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6998 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6999
7000 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7001 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7002 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7003 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7004 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7005 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7006 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7007 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7008 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7009 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7010 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7011 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7012 @end example
7013
7014 psoc6-specific commands
7015 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7016 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7017 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7018 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7019 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7020 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7024 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7025 by @command{flash banks}.
7026 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7027 @end deffn
7028 @end deffn
7029
7030 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7031 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7032 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7033 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7034 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7035
7036 @example
7037 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7038 @end example
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7042 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7043 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7044 and SWD interface.
7045 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7046 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7047
7048 @example
7049 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7050 @end example
7051
7052 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7053
7054 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7055 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7056 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7060 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7061 @end deffn
7062 @end deffn
7063
7064 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7065 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7066 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7067 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7068 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7069
7070 @example
7071 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7072 @end example
7073
7074 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7075 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7076 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7077 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7078 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7079 disabled.
7080
7081 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7082 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7083 @quotation Warning
7084 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7085 applied to all of them.
7086 @end quotation
7087 @end deffn
7088 @end deffn
7089
7090 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7091 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7092 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7093 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7094 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7095 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7096
7097 @example
7098 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7099 @end example
7100
7101 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7102 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7103 the flash driver.
7104
7105 @example
7106 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7107 @end example
7108
7109 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7110 as per the following example.
7111 @example
7112 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7113 @end example
7114
7115 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7116
7117 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7118 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7119 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7120 @end deffn
7121
7122 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7123 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7124 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7125 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7129 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7130 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7131 @end deffn
7132
7133 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7134 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7135 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7136 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7140 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7141 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7142 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7146 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7147 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7148 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7149 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7150 @end deffn
7151 @end deffn
7152
7153 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7154 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7155 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7156 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7157 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7158
7159 @example
7160 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7161 @end example
7162
7163 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7164 as per the following example.
7165 @example
7166 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7167 @end example
7168
7169 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7170 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7171 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7175 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7176 the flash driver.
7177
7178 @example
7179 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7180 @end example
7181
7182 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7183
7184 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7185 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7186 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7187 @end deffn
7188
7189 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7190 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7191 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7195 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7197 @end deffn
7198
7199 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7200 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7201 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7205 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7206 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7207 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7208 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7209 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7213 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7214 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7215 @end deffn
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7219 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7220 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7221 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7222 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7223
7224 @example
7225 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7226 @end example
7227
7228 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7229 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7230 the flash driver.
7231
7232 @example
7233 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7234 @end example
7235
7236 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7237
7238 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7239 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7240 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7241 @end deffn
7242
7243 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7244 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7245 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7249 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7250 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7254 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7255 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7256 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7257 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7258
7259 Example usage:
7260 @example
7261 # read OPTSR_CUR
7262 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7263 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7264 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7265 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7266 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7267 @end example
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7271 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7272 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7273 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7274 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7275 will be touched).
7276
7277 Example usage:
7278 @example
7279 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7280 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7281 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7282 @end example
7283 @end deffn
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7287 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7288 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7289 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7290 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7291
7292 @example
7293 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7294 @end example
7295
7296 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7297 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7298 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7299 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7300 second bank.
7301
7302 @example
7303 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7304 @end example
7305
7306 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7307
7308 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7309 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7310 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7311 @end deffn
7312
7313 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7314 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7315 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7319 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7320 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7321 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7322 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7323 @end deffn
7324 @end deffn
7325
7326 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7327 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7328 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7329 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7330 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7331 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7332
7333 @example
7334 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7335 @end example
7336
7337 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7338 as per the following example.
7339 @example
7340 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7341 @end example
7342
7343 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7344 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7345 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7346 @end deffn
7347
7348 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7349 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7350 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7351 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7352
7353 @example
7354 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7355 @end example
7356
7357 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7358
7359 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7360 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7361 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7362
7363 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7367 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7368 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7369
7370 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7371 @end deffn
7372
7373 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7374 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7375 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7376 @end deffn
7377
7378 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7379 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7380 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7381 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7382
7383 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7384 @example
7385 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7386 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7387 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7388 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7389 @end example
7390
7391 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7392 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7393 @end deffn
7394
7395 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7396 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7397 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7398 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7399 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7400
7401 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7402
7403 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7404 @example
7405 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7406 @end example
7407
7408 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7409 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7410 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7414 List the protected areas using WRP.
7415 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7416 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7417 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7418
7419 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7420 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7421 in single or dual-banks mode.
7422 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7423 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7424
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7428 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7429 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7430 @end deffn
7431
7432 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7433 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7434 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7435 the TrustZone status.
7436 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7437 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7438 @end deffn
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7442 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7443 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7444 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7445 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7446
7447 @example
7448 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7449 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7450 @end example
7451
7452 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7453 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7454 for the specified flash bank.
7455 @end deffn
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7459 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7460 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7461 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7462 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7463
7464 @example
7465 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7466 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7467 @end example
7468
7469 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7470 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7471 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7472
7473 @itemize @bullet
7474 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7475 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7476 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7477 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7478 @end itemize
7479 @end deffn
7480
7481 @end deffn
7482
7483 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7484 @cindex str9xpec
7485
7486 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7487 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7488 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7489 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7490
7491 Here is some background info to help
7492 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7493 the str9:
7494 @enumerate
7495 @item
7496 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7497 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7498 @item
7499 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7500 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7501 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7502 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7503 @end enumerate
7504
7505 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7506 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7507 configured for flash bank 0.
7508 @example
7509 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7510 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7511 adapter assert srst
7512 # turn off target polling
7513 poll off
7514 # disable str9 core
7515 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7516 # read option bytes
7517 str9xpec options_read 0
7518 # re-enable str9 core
7519 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7520 poll on
7521 reset halt
7522 @end example
7523 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7524 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7525 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7526 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7527
7528 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7529
7530 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7531 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7532 @end deffn
7533
7534 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7535 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7536 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7540 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7541 erase the device.
7542 @end deffn
7543
7544 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7545 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7549 Configure str9 boot bank.
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7553 Configure str9 lvd source.
7554 @end deffn
7555
7556 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7557 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7561 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7562 @end deffn
7563
7564 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7565 Read str9 option bytes.
7566 @end deffn
7567
7568 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7569 Write str9 option bytes.
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7573 unlock str9 device.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7579 @cindex swm050
7580 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7581
7582 @example
7583 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7584 @end example
7585
7586 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7587
7588 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7589 Erases the entire flash bank.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @end deffn
7593
7594
7595 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7596 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7597 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7598 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7599
7600 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7601
7602 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7603 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7604 @end deffn
7605
7606 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7607 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7611 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7612 the flash clock.
7613 @end deffn
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7617 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7618 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7619 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7620 correct bank config.
7621
7622 @example
7623 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7624 @end example
7625 @end deffn
7626
7627 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7628 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7629 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7633 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7634 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7635
7636 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7637
7638 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7639 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7640 @end deffn
7641
7642 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7643 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7644 @end deffn
7645
7646 @end deffn
7647
7648 @section NAND Flash Commands
7649 @cindex NAND
7650
7651 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7652 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7653 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7654
7655 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7656 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7657 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7658 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7659 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7660 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7661
7662 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7663 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7664 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7665 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7666 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7667 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7668 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7669 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7670 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7671 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7672
7673 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7674 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7675 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7676 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7677 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7678 every 512 bytes of data.
7679
7680 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7681 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7682 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7683 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7684 ECC mode is used.
7685
7686 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7687 @enumerate
7688 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7689 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7690 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7691 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7692 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7693 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7694 to access that device.
7695 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7696 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7697 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7698 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7699 de-brick a board.
7700 @end enumerate
7701
7702 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7703 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7704 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7705 are only 32 bits wide.
7706 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7707 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7708 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7709 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7710
7711 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7712 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7713 @cindex NAND configuration
7714
7715 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7716 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7717 OpenOCD has initialized.
7718
7719 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7720 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7721 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7722 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7723 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7724 they were a single (larger) device.
7725 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7726 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7727
7728 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7729 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7730 configuration files, not interactively.
7731
7732 @itemize @bullet
7733 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7734 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7735 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7736 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7737 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7738 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7739 commands to the NAND controller.
7740 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7741 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7742 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7743 for more information.
7744 @end itemize
7745 @end deffn
7746
7747 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7748 Prints a summary of each device declared
7749 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7750 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7751 @example
7752 > nand list
7753 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7754 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7755 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7756 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7757 >
7758 @end example
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7762 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7763 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7764 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7765 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7766 it with most other NAND commands.
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7770
7771 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7772 @cindex NAND reading
7773 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7774 starting at the specified offset.
7775 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7776
7777 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7778 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7779
7780 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7781 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7782 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7783
7784 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7785 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7786 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7787 method which handled that error correction.
7788
7789 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7790 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7791 @itemize @bullet
7792 @item no oob_* parameter
7793 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7794 @item @code{oob_raw}
7795 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7796 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7797 spare areas associated with each data page.
7798 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7799 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7800 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7801 @item @code{oob_only}
7802 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7803 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7804 spare areas associated with each data page.
7805 @end itemize
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7809 @cindex NAND erasing
7810 @cindex NAND programming
7811 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7812 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7813 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7814 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7815 If those parameters are not specified,
7816 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7817 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7818
7819 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7820 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7821 block marker.
7822 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7823 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7827 @cindex NAND writing
7828 @cindex NAND programming
7829 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7830 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7831 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7832 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7833
7834 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7835 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7836
7837 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7838 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7839 past the end of the device.
7840 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7841 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7842 if that's being written.)
7843
7844 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7845 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7846 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7847
7848 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7849 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7850 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7851 @itemize @bullet
7852 @item no oob_* parameter
7853 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7854 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7855 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7856 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7857 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7858 @item @code{oob_only}
7859 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7860 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7861 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7862 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7863 @item @code{oob_raw}
7864 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7865 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7866 un-altered OOB.
7867 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7868 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7869 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7870 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7871 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7872 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7873 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7874 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7875 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7876 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7877 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7878 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7879 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7880 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7881 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7882 @end itemize
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7886 @cindex NAND verification
7887 @cindex NAND programming
7888 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7889 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7890 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7891
7892 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7893 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7894
7895 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7896 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7897 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7898 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7899 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7900
7901 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7902 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7903 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7904
7905 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7906 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7907 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7908 be removed in a future release.
7909 @end deffn
7910
7911 @subsection Other NAND commands
7912 @cindex NAND other commands
7913
7914 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7915 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7916 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7917 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7918 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7919 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7920 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7921 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7922
7923 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7924 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7925 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7929 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7930 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7931 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7932 status for each block.
7933 @end deffn
7934
7935 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7936 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7937 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7938
7939 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7940 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7941 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7942 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7943 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7944
7945 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7946 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7947 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7948 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7949 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7950 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7951 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7952 @end deffn
7953
7954 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7955 @subsection NAND Driver List
7956 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7957 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7958 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7959
7960 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
7961 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7962 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7963 address of the ECC controller.
7964 @example
7965 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7966 @end example
7967 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7968 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7969 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7970 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7971 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7972 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7973 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7974 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7975 @end deffn
7976 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7977 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7978 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7979 @end deffn
7980
7981 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7982 properly configured for input or output.
7983 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7984 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7985 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7986 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7987 @end deffn
7988 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7989 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7990 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7991 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7992 @end deffn
7993 @end deffn
7994
7995 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
7996 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7997 chips from Texas Instruments.
7998 It takes three extra parameters:
7999 address of the NAND chip;
8000 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8001 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8002 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8003 @example
8004 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8005 @end example
8006 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8007 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8008 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8009 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8010 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8011 @end deffn
8012
8013 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8014 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8015 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8016 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8017 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8018 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8019 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8020 @end deffn
8021
8022 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8023 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8024 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8025 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8026 @end deffn
8027 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8028
8029 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8030 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8031 should work for this chip as well.
8032 @end deffn
8033
8034 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8035 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8036 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8037 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8038 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8039 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8040 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8041 @example
8042 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8043 @end example
8044 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8045 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8046 without parameter query status.
8047 @end deffn
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8051 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8052 parameter: the address of the controller.
8053 @example
8054 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8055 @end example
8056 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8057 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8058 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8059 change any behavior.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8063 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8064 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8065 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8066 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8067 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8068 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8069 specialized commands.
8070 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8071 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8072 change any behavior.
8073 @end deffn
8074
8075 @node Flash Programming
8076 @chapter Flash Programming
8077
8078 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8079 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8080 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8081
8082 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8083 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8084
8085 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8086 @enumerate
8087 @item 'init' is executed.
8088 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8089 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8090 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8091 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8092 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8093 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8094 @end enumerate
8095
8096 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8097
8098 @example
8099 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8100 # are optional parameters
8101 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8102 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8103
8104 # binary files need the flash address passing
8105 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8106 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8107 @end example
8108
8109 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8110 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8111 @cindex PLD
8112 @cindex FPGA
8113
8114 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8115 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8116 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8117 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8118 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8119 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8120 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8121
8122 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8123
8124 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8125 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8126 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8127
8128 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8129 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8130
8131 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8132 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8133 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8134 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8135 behavior.
8136 @end deffn
8137
8138 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8139 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8140 @end deffn
8141
8142 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8143 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8144 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8145 @end deffn
8146
8147 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8148
8149 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8150 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8151 that particular type of PLD.
8152
8153 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8154 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8155 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8156
8157 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8158 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8159 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8160
8161 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8162 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8163 for FPGA @var{num}.
8164 @end deffn
8165 @end deffn
8166
8167 @node General Commands
8168 @chapter General Commands
8169 @cindex commands
8170
8171 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8172 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8173 commands are documented elsewhere.
8174
8175 Intent:
8176 @itemize @bullet
8177 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8178 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8179 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8180 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8181
8182 @item @b{From the human}
8183 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8184 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8185
8186 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8187 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8188 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8189
8190 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8191 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8192 port is 5555.
8193 @end itemize
8194
8195
8196 @section Server Commands
8197
8198 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8199 Exits the current telnet session.
8200 @end deffn
8201
8202 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8203 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8204 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8205 Not every command provides helptext.
8206
8207 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8208 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8209 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8210 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8211 @end deffn
8212
8213 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8214 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8215 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8216 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8217 Useful in connection with script files
8218 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8219 @end deffn
8220
8221 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8222 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8223 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8224 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8225
8226 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8227 @example
8228 # redefine shutdown
8229 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8230 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8231 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8232 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8233 original_shutdown
8234 @}
8235 @end example
8236 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8237 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8238 @end deffn
8239
8240 @anchor{debuglevel}
8241 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8242 @cindex message level
8243 Display debug level.
8244 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8245 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8246 Level 0 is error messages only;
8247 level 1 adds warnings;
8248 level 2 adds informational messages;
8249 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8250 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8251 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8252 the command line along with the location of that log
8253 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8254 @xref{Running}.
8255 @end deffn
8256
8257 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8258 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8259 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8260 @example
8261 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8262 @end example
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8266 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8267 the default log output channel is stderr.
8268 @end deffn
8269
8270 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8271 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8272 @end deffn
8273
8274 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8275 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8276 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8277 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8278 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8282 @section Target State handling
8283 @cindex reset
8284 @cindex halt
8285 @cindex target initialization
8286
8287 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8288 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8289 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8290 a current target which is used to perform the
8291 various operations. The current target may be changed
8292 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8293 target which should become current.
8294
8295 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8296 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8297 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8298 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8299 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8300
8301 @emph{With no arguments}:
8302 list all available registers for the current target,
8303 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8304 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8305 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8306 are flagged as such.
8307
8308 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8309 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8310 bypassing any internal cache.
8311
8312 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8313 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8314 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8315 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8316 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8317 relevant module will flush such values.
8318
8319 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8320 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8321
8322 @example
8323 > reg
8324 ===== ARM registers
8325 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8326 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8327 (2) r2 (/32)
8328 ...
8329 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8330 >
8331 @end example
8332 @end deffn
8333
8334 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8335 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8336 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8337 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8338 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8339 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8340 (and enter debug mode).
8341 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8342
8343 @quotation Warning
8344 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8345 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8346 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8347 power mode by gating the core clock;
8348 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8349
8350 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8351 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8352 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8353 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8354 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8355 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8356
8357 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8358 work with a JTAG debugger.
8359 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8360 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8361 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8362 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8363 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8364 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8365 @end quotation
8366
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8370 Resume the target at its current code position,
8371 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8372 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8373 @end deffn
8374
8375 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8376 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8377 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8378 @end deffn
8379
8380 @anchor{resetcommand}
8381 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8382 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8383 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8384 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8385 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8386 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8387 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8388
8389 The optional parameter specifies what should
8390 happen after the reset.
8391 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8392 The other options will not work on all systems.
8393 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8394
8395 @itemize @minus
8396 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8397 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8398 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8399 @end itemize
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8403 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8404 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8405 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8406 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8407 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8408 state.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8412 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8413 Set values of reset signals.
8414 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8415 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8416 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8417 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8418
8419 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8420 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8421 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8422 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8423 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8424 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8425 the signal will not be modified.
8426
8427 @quotation Note
8428 TRST is specially handled.
8429 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8430 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8431 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8432 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8433 instead of the TRST signal.
8434 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8435 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8436 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8437 with handlers for that event.
8438 @end quotation
8439 @end deffn
8440
8441 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8442 @section Memory access commands
8443 @cindex memory access
8444
8445 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8446 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8447 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8448 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8449
8450 @enumerate
8451 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8452 to change the current target.
8453 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8454 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8455 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8456 @end enumerate
8457
8458 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8459 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8460 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8461 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8462 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8463 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8464 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8465 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8466 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8467 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8468 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8469 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8470 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8471 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8472 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8476 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8477 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8478 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8479 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8480 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8481 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8482 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8483 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8484 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8485 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8486 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @anchor{imageaccess}
8490 @section Image loading commands
8491 @cindex image loading
8492 @cindex image dumping
8493
8494 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8495 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8496 binary file named @var{filename}.
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8500 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8501 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8502 @end deffn
8503
8504 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8505 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8506 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8507 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8508 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8509 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8510 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8511 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8512 separately.
8513 @end deffn
8514
8515 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8516 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8517 The file format may optionally be specified
8518 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8519 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8520 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8521 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8522 @example
8523 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8524 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8525 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8526 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8527 $address $length
8528 @}
8529 @end example
8530 @end deffn
8531
8532 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8533 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8534 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8535 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8536 The file format may optionally be specified
8537 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8541 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8542 The file format may optionally be specified
8543 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8544 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8548 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8549 The file format may optionally be specified
8550 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8551 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8552 @end deffn
8553
8554
8555 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8556 @cindex breakpoint
8557 @cindex watchpoint
8558
8559 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8560 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8561 watchpoints.
8562 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8563
8564 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8565 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8566 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8567 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8568 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8569 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8570
8571 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8572 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8576 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8577 @end deffn
8578
8579 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8580 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8584 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8585 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8586 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8587 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8588 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8589 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8590 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8591 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594
8595 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8596
8597 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8598 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8599 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8600 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8601 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8602 running, can be used.
8603 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8604 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8605 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8606
8607 @quotation Note
8608 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8609 @end quotation
8610
8611 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8612 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8613 communication, respectively.
8614
8615 @quotation Note
8616 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8617 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8618 example.
8619 @end quotation
8620
8621 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8622 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8623 of TCP/IP connections.
8624
8625 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8626 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8627 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8628 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8629 @var{size} bytes.
8630 @end deffn
8631
8632 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8633 Start RTT.
8634 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8635 @end deffn
8636
8637 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8638 Stop RTT.
8639 @end deffn
8640
8641 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8642 Display the polling interval.
8643 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8644 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8645 checked for new data.
8646 @end deffn
8647
8648 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8649 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8650 @end deffn
8651
8652 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8653 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8654 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8658 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8662 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8663 @end deffn
8664
8665 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8666 on the target device.
8667
8668 @example
8669 resume
8670
8671 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8672 rtt start
8673
8674 rtt server start 9090 0
8675 @end example
8676
8677 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8678 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8679 TCP/IP port 9090.
8680
8681
8682 @section Misc Commands
8683
8684 @cindex profiling
8685 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8686 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8687 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8688 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8689 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8690 limit the address range.
8691 @end deffn
8692
8693 @deffn {Command} {version}
8694 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8695 @end deffn
8696
8697 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8698 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8699 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8703 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8704 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8705 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8706
8707 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8708 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8709 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8710 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8711
8712 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8713 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8714 @cindex tracing
8715 @cindex ETM
8716 @cindex ETB
8717
8718 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8719 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8720 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8721
8722 @itemize
8723 @item
8724 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8725 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8726 supports such an interface.
8727 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8728 and trace port support.)
8729 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8730 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8731 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8732 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8733 in the board-specific configuration file.
8734 @item
8735 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8736 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8737 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8738 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8739 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8740 @end itemize
8741
8742 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8743
8744 @quotation Issues
8745 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8746 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8747
8748 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8749 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8750 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8751 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8752 dummy trace port driver}.
8753
8754 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8755 as well as tracing only during specific states
8756 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8757
8758 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8759 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8760 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8761 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8762 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8763
8764 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8765 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8766 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8767 this original style of JTAG access.
8768 @end quotation
8769
8770 @subsection ETM Configuration
8771 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8772
8773 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8774 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8775 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8776
8777 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8778 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8779 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8780 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8781 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8782 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8783 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8784 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8785 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8786
8787 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8788 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8789 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8790
8791 @quotation Warning
8792 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8793 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8794 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8795 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8796 @end quotation
8797
8798 @quotation Note
8799 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8800 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8801 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8802 what CPU activities are traced.
8803 @end quotation
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8807 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8808 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8809 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8810 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8811 @end deffn
8812
8813 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8814 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8815 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8816 Did trace data overflow?
8817 Was it triggered?
8818 @end deffn
8819
8820 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8821 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8822 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8823 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8824 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8825
8826 @itemize
8827 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8828 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8829 The value is one of
8830 @option{none} (save nothing),
8831 @option{data} (save data),
8832 @option{address} (save addresses),
8833 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8834 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8835 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8836 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8837 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8838 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8839 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8840 trace stream without an image of the code.
8841 @end itemize
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8845 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8846 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8847 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8848 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8849
8850 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8851 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8852 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8853 @end deffn
8854
8855 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8856
8857 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8858 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8859 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8860
8861 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8862 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8863 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8864 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8865 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8866 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8867 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8868
8869 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8870
8871 @itemize
8872 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8873 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8874 for instruction access within that function's body.
8875 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8876 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8877 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8878 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8879 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8880 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8881 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8882 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8883 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8884 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8885 @item @emph{... more}
8886 @end itemize
8887
8888 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8889 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8890
8891 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8892 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8893 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8894 @end deffn
8895
8896 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8897 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8898 @end deffn
8899
8900 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8901 Opens an image file.
8902 @end deffn
8903
8904 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8905 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8906 @end deffn
8907
8908 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8909 Starts trace data collection.
8910 @end deffn
8911
8912 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8913 Stops trace data collection.
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8917 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8918
8919 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8920
8921 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8922 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8923 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8924 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8925 any trace data collection.}
8926 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8927 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8928 @end deffn
8929 @end deffn
8930
8931 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8932 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8933 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8934 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8935 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8936 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8937 @end deffn
8938 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8939 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8940 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8941 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8942 trace trigger becomes active.
8943
8944 @itemize
8945 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8946 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8947 afterwards.
8948 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8949 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8950 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8951 what caused that event to happen.
8952 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8953 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8954 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8955 how the event caused trouble.
8956 @end itemize
8957 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8958 @end deffn
8959
8960 @end deffn
8961
8962 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8963 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8964 @cindex CTI
8965
8966 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8967 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8968 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8969 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8970 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8971 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8972
8973 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8974 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8975 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8976 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8977 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8978 including additional configuration.
8979 @end deffn
8980
8981 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8982 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8983 @end deffn
8984
8985 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
8986 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8987 @end deffn
8988
8989 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8990 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8991 @end deffn
8992
8993 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8994 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8998 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9002 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9003 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9004 @end deffn
9005
9006 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9007 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9008 of the CTI.
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9012 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9013 useful in TCL scripting.
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @section Generic ARM
9017 @cindex ARM
9018
9019 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9020 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9021 commands that may be available.
9022
9023 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9024 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9025 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9026 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9027 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9028 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9032 @cindex disassemble
9033 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9034 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9035 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9036 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9037 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9038 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9039 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9040
9041 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9042 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9043 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9044 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9045 with a handful of exceptions.
9046 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9047 @end deffn
9048
9049 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9050 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9051 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9052 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9053 and using the MCR instruction.
9054 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9055 an ARM register.)
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9059 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9060 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9061 and the MRC instruction.
9062 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9063 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9064 an ARM register.)
9065 @end deffn
9066
9067 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9068 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9069 core mode if necessary.
9070 @end deffn
9071
9072 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9073 @cindex ARM semihosting
9074 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9075
9076 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9077 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9078 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9079 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9080 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9081 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9085 @cindex ARM semihosting
9086 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9087
9088 @example
9089 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9090 @end example
9091
9092 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9093 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9094 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9095 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9096 @end deffn
9097
9098 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9099 @cindex ARM semihosting
9100 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9101 status.
9102
9103 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9104 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9105 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9106 debugger.
9107 @end deffn
9108
9109 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9110 @cindex ARM semihosting
9111 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9112
9113 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9114 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9115 the value returned by the target.
9116
9117 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9118 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9119 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9120 encountering a break.
9121
9122 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9123 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9124 to the debugger.
9125 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9126 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9127 request or equivalent").
9128
9129 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9130 this option (default: disabled).
9131 @end deffn
9132
9133 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9134 @cindex ARMv4
9135 @cindex ARMv5
9136
9137 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9138 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9139 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9140 variant.
9141
9142 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9143 @cindex ARM7
9144 @cindex ARM9
9145
9146 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9147 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9148 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9149 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9150
9151 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9152 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9153 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9154 instead of breakpoints.
9155 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9156
9157 This should be
9158 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9159 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9160 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9164 @cindex DCC
9165 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9166 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9167 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9168
9169 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9170 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9171 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9172 @end deffn
9173
9174 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9175 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9176 that don't check completion of the operation.
9177 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9178
9179 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9180 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9181 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9182 @end deffn
9183
9184 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9185 @cindex ARM9
9186
9187 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9188 integer processors.
9189 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9190
9191 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9192 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9193 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9194 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9195
9196 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9197 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9198 @cindex vector_catch
9199 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9200 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9201 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9202 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9203 to those hardware vectors.
9204
9205 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9206 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9207 vector catch hardware to intercept
9208 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9209 @option{none} of them,
9210 or a list with one or more of the following:
9211 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9212 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9213 @end deffn
9214
9215 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9216 @cindex ARM920T
9217
9218 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9219 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9220 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9221 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9222 and ARM9 commands.
9223
9224 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9225 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9226 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9227 @end deffn
9228
9229 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9230 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9231 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9232 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9233 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9234 (Not all registers can be written.)
9235 @end deffn
9236
9237 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9238 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9239 @end deffn
9240
9241 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9242 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9243 @end deffn
9244
9245 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9246 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9247
9248 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9249 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9250 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9251 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9252 and ARM9 commands.
9253
9254 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9255 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9256
9257 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9258 Print information about the caches found.
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9262 @cindex ARM966E
9263
9264 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9265 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9266 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9267 and ARM9 commands.
9268
9269 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9270 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9271 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9272 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9273 ARM966E-S TRM.
9274 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9275 as required for BIST support.
9276 @end deffn
9277
9278 @subsection XScale specific commands
9279 @cindex XScale
9280
9281 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9282
9283 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9284 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9285 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9286 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9287 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9288 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9289 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9290
9291 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9292 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9293 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9294 the mini-IC.
9295
9296 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9297 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9298 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9299 code layout in memory:
9300 @example
9301 _vectors:
9302 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9303 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9304 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9305 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9306 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9307 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9308 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9309 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9310 .org 0x100
9311 .long real_reset_vector
9312 .long real_ui_handler
9313 .long real_swi_handler
9314 .long real_pf_abort
9315 .long real_data_abort
9316 .long 0 /* unused */
9317 .long real_irq_handler
9318 .long real_fiq_handler
9319 @end example
9320
9321 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9322 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9323 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9324 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9325 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9326 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9327 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9328 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9329 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9330 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9331 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9332 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9333 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9334 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9335 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9336 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9337 software.
9338
9339 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9340 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9341 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9342 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9343
9344 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9345 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9346 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9347 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9348 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9349 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9350 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9351 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9352 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9353
9354 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9355 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9356
9357 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9358 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9359 @end deffn
9360
9361 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9362 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9366 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9367 @end deffn
9368
9369 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9370 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9371 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9372 @end deffn
9373
9374 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9375 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9376 @end deffn
9377
9378 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9379 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9380 @end deffn
9381
9382 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9383 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9384 @end deffn
9385
9386 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9387 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9391 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9392 @end deffn
9393
9394 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9395 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9396 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9397 and modifying how it is emptied.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9401 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9402 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9403 The image @var{type} may be one of
9404 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9405 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9406 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9407 @end deffn
9408
9409 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9410 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9411 @cindex vector_catch
9412 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9413 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9414
9415 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9416 @example
9417 0x01 Trap Reset
9418 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9419 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9420 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9421 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9422 0x20 reserved
9423 0x40 Trap IRQ
9424 0x80 Trap FIQ
9425 @end example
9426 @end deffn
9427
9428 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9429 @cindex vector_table
9430
9431 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9432 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9433 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9434 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9435 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9436
9437 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9438
9439 @end deffn
9440
9441 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9442 @cindex ARMv6
9443
9444 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9445 @cindex ARM11
9446
9447 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9448 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9449 which is enabled by default.
9450 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9451 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9452 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9453 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9454 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9455 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9456 @end deffn
9457
9458 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9459 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9460 which is enabled by default.
9461 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9462 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9466 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9467 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9468 they are disabled by default.
9469 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9470 @end deffn
9471
9472 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9473 @cindex vector_catch
9474 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9475 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9476 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9477
9478 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9479 for certain hardware events.
9480 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9481 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9482 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9483 @end deffn
9484
9485 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9486 @cindex ARMv7
9487 @cindex ARMv8
9488
9489 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9490 @cindex Cortex-A
9491
9492 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9493 display information about target caches
9494 @end deffn
9495
9496 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9497 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9498 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9499 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9500 Defaults to 'off'.
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9504 Initialize core debug
9505 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9506 @end deffn
9507
9508 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9509 Display/set the current SMP mode
9510 @end deffn
9511
9512 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9513 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9517 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9521 configure l2x cache
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9525 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9526 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9527 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9528 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9529 @end deffn
9530
9531 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9532 @cindex Cortex-R
9533
9534 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9535 Initialize core debug
9536 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9537 @end deffn
9538
9539 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9540 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9541 @end deffn
9542
9543
9544 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9545 @cindex tracing
9546 @cindex SWO
9547 @cindex SWV
9548 @cindex TPIU
9549
9550 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9551 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9552 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9553 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9554
9555 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9556 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9557 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9558 which causes quite some confusion.
9559 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9560 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9561
9562 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9563 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9564 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9565
9566 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9567 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9568 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9569 @end deffn
9570
9571 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9572 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9573 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9574 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9575
9576 @itemize @bullet
9577 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9578 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9579 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9580 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9581
9582 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9583 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9584 @end itemize
9585 @end deffn
9586
9587 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9588 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9589 @end deffn
9590
9591 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9592 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9593 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9594 at any time after the initialization, too.
9595 @end deffn
9596
9597 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9598 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9599 individually queried, to return its current value.
9600 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9601 @end deffn
9602
9603 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9604 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9605 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9606 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9607
9608 @itemize @bullet
9609 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9610 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9611
9612 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9613 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9614
9615 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9616 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9617
9618 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9619 protocol used for trace data:
9620 @itemize @minus
9621 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9622 data bits (default);
9623 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9624 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9625 @end itemize
9626
9627 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9628 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9629 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9630 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9631 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9632 of the TPIU.
9633
9634 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9635 the destination of the trace data:
9636 @itemize @minus
9637 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9638 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9639 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9640 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9641 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9642 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9643 each connected client;
9644 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9645 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9646 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9647 @end itemize
9648
9649 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9650 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9651 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9652 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9653
9654 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9655 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9656 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9657 maximum supported rate automatically.
9658
9659 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9660 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9661 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9662
9663 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9664 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9665 default value is @var{0}.
9666 @end itemize
9667 @end deffn
9668
9669 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9670 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9671 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9672 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9673 data.
9674 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9675 after the @command{init}.
9676 @end deffn
9677
9678 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9679 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9680 @end deffn
9681
9682
9683
9684 Example usage:
9685 @enumerate
9686 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9687 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9688 enough to:
9689 @example
9690 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9691 ...
9692 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9693 ...
9694 @end example
9695 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9696 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9697 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9698 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9699 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9700 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9701 @example
9702 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9703 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9704 @end example
9705 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9706 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9707 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9708 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9709 @example
9710 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9711 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9712 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9713 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9714 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9715 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9716 @end example
9717 @end enumerate
9718
9719 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9720 @cindex tracing
9721 @cindex SWO
9722 @cindex SWV
9723 @cindex ITM
9724 @cindex ETM
9725
9726 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9727 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9728 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9729 @end deffn
9730
9731 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9732 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9733 @end deffn
9734
9735 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9736 @cindex Cortex-M
9737
9738 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9739 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9740
9741 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9742 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9743 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9744 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9745 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9746 the step command leaves with the core running.
9747
9748 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9749 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9750 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9751 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9752
9753 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9754 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9755 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9756 does.
9757
9758 Default is @option{auto}.
9759 @end deffn
9760
9761 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9762 @cindex vector_catch
9763 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9764 for certain hardware events.
9765
9766 Parameters request interception of
9767 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9768 @option{none} of them,
9769 or one or more of the following:
9770 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9771 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9772 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9773 @option{irq_err},
9774 @option{state_err},
9775 @option{chk_err}, or
9776 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9777 @option{reset}.
9778 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9779 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9780 are mapped to HardFault.
9781 UsageFault checks for
9782 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9783 must also be explicitly enabled.
9784
9785 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9786 @end deffn
9787
9788 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9789 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9790 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9791
9792 @itemize @minus
9793 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9794 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9795 @end itemize
9796
9797 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9798 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9799 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9800 to manually reset the peripherals.
9801 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9802
9803 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9804 instead.
9805 @end deffn
9806
9807 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9808 @cindex ARMv8-A
9809 @cindex aarch64
9810
9811 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9812 Display information about target caches
9813 @end deffn
9814
9815 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9816 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9817 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9818 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9819 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9820 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9824 @cindex disassemble
9825 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9826 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9827 @end deffn
9828
9829 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9830 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9831 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9832 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9833 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9837 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9838 @option{on}.
9839 @end deffn
9840
9841 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9842 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9843 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9844 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9845 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9846 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9847 @end deffn
9848
9849 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9850
9851 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9852 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9853
9854 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9855
9856 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9857 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9858 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9862 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9863 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9864 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9865 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9866 @end deffn
9867
9868 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9869
9870 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9871 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9872 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9873 @end deffn
9874
9875 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9876
9877 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9878 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9879 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9880 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9881 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9882 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9883 can be collected.
9884
9885 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9886 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9887 tooling.
9888
9889 @quotation Issues
9890 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9891 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9892 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9893 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9894
9895 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9896 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9897 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9898 software operation on the CPU.
9899 @end quotation
9900
9901 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9902 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9903 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9904 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9905 @end deffn
9906
9907 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9908 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9909 @end deffn
9910
9911 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9912 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9913 control is disabled.
9914 @end deffn
9915
9916 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9917 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9918 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9919 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9920
9921 Supported trace formats:
9922 @itemize
9923 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9924 timing to be determined.
9925 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9926 addresses.
9927 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9928 @end itemize
9929 @end deffn
9930
9931 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9932 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9933 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9934 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9935
9936 Supported conditions:
9937 @itemize
9938 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9939 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9940 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9941 instruction matches start data and mask.
9942 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9943 instruction matches start data and mask.
9944 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9945 data and mask.
9946 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9947 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9948 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9949 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9950 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9951 @end itemize
9952 @end deffn
9953
9954 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9955 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9956 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9957 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9958
9959 Supported conditions:
9960 @itemize
9961 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9962 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9963 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9964 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9965 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9966 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9967 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9968 data and mask.
9969 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9970 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9971 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9972 @end itemize
9973 @end deffn
9974
9975 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9976 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9977
9978 Supported triggers:
9979 @itemize
9980 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9981 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9982 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9983 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9984 collection.
9985 @end itemize
9986 @end deffn
9987
9988 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9989
9990 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
9991 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9992 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9993 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9994 @end deffn
9995
9996 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
9997 Display trace configuration.
9998 @end deffn
9999
10000 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10001 Display trace collection status.
10002 @end deffn
10003
10004 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10005 Start manual trace collection.
10006 @end deffn
10007
10008 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10009 Stop manual trace collection.
10010 @end deffn
10011
10012 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10013 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10014 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10015 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10016 @option{size} options using DMA.
10017 @end deffn
10018
10019 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10020 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10021 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10022 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10023 @option{size} options using DMA.
10024 @end deffn
10025
10026 @section Intel Architecture
10027
10028 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10029 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10030 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10031 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10032 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10033 @itemize
10034 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10035 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10036 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10037 @end itemize
10038
10039 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10040 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10041 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10042
10043 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10044 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10045 @end deffn
10046
10047 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10048 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10049 @end deffn
10050
10051 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10052 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10053 @end deffn
10054
10055 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10056 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10057 @end deffn
10058
10059 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10060 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10061 @end deffn
10062
10063 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10064 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10065 @end deffn
10066
10067 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10068
10069 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10070 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10071
10072 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10073 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10074 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10075 @end deffn
10076 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10077 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10078
10079 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10080
10081 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10082 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10083 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10084 @end deffn
10085
10086 @subsection Registers commands
10087 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10088 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10089 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10090
10091 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10092
10093 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10094 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10095 and "timer" groups.
10096
10097 @emph{example:}
10098 @example
10099 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10100 @end example
10101
10102 @end deffn
10103
10104 @section RISC-V Architecture
10105
10106 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10107 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10108 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10109 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10110 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10111 implement version 0.11.
10112
10113 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10114
10115 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10116 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10117 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10118
10119 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10120
10121 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10122 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10123 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10124
10125 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10126 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10127 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10128 CSRs.
10129 @end deffn
10130
10131 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10132 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10133 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10134 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10135 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10136 This command must be executed before `init`.
10137 @end deffn
10138
10139 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10140 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10141 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10142 @end deffn
10143
10144 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10145 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10146 deasserted.
10147 @end deffn
10148
10149 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10150 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10151 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10152 @end deffn
10153
10154 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10155 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10156 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10157 on physical memory.
10158 @end deffn
10159
10160 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10161 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10162 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10163 performed on physical memory.
10164 @end deffn
10165
10166 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10167 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10168 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10169 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10170 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10171 race condition problem in your code.
10172
10173 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10174 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10175 @end deffn
10176
10177 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10178 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10179 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10180 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10181 values.
10182
10183 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10184 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10185 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10186 @end deffn
10187
10188 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10189 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10190 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10191 @end deffn
10192
10193 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10194 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10195 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10196 @end deffn
10197
10198 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10199 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10200 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10201 @end deffn
10202
10203 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10204 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10205 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10206 @end deffn
10207
10208 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10209
10210 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10211 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10212 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10213 @example
10214 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10215 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10216 @end example
10217
10218 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10219 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10220 @end deffn
10221
10222 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10223 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10224 @end deffn
10225
10226 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10227
10228 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10229 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10230
10231 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10232 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10233 @end deffn
10234
10235 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10236 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10237 @end deffn
10238
10239 @section ARC Architecture
10240 @cindex ARC
10241
10242 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10243 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10244 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10245 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10246 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10247 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10248 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10249 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10250 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10251 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10252 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10253 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10254 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10255 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10256 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10257
10258
10259 @subsection General ARC commands
10260
10261 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10262
10263 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10264 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10265 arguments:
10266
10267 @itemize @bullet
10268
10269 @item @code{-name} name
10270 @*Name of a register.
10271
10272 @item @code{-num} number
10273 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10274
10275 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10276 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10277
10278 @end itemize
10279
10280 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10281
10282 @itemize @bullet
10283
10284 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10285 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10286 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10287 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10288 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10289 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10290
10291 @item @code{-core}
10292 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10293 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10294 spaces.
10295
10296 @item @code{-bcr}
10297 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10298 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10299 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10300 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10301 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10302
10303 @item @code{-type} type_name
10304 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10305 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10306
10307 @item @code{-g}
10308 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10309 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10310 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10311 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10312 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10313
10314 @end itemize
10315
10316 @end deffn
10317
10318 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10319 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10320 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10321 @end deffn
10322
10323 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10324 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10325 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10326 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10327 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10328 startbit endbit}.
10329 @end deffn
10330
10331 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10332 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10333 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10334 @end deffn
10335
10336 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10337 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10338 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10339 @end deffn
10340
10341 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10342
10343 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10344 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10345 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10346 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10347
10348 @end deffn
10349
10350 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10351 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10352 registers.
10353 @end deffn
10354
10355 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10356 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10357 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10358 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10359
10360 @end deffn
10361
10362 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10363 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10364 registers.
10365 @end deffn
10366
10367 @section STM8 Architecture
10368 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10369 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10370
10371 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10372 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10373
10374 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10375 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10376 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10377 @cindex tracing
10378 @cindex libdcc
10379 @cindex DCC
10380 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10381 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10382 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10383 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10384
10385 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10386 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10387 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10388 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10389 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10390 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10391
10392 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10393 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10394 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10395 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10396 The target being debugged may
10397 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10398 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10399 each supported by a command:
10400
10401 @itemize
10402 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10403 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10404 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10405 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10406
10407 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10408 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10409 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10410
10411 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10412 and then displayed at any time.
10413 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10414
10415 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10416 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10417 @end itemize
10418
10419 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10420 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10421 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10422 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10423 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10424 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10425 does the same thing.
10426
10427 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10428 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10429 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10430 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10431 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10432
10433 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10434 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10435 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10436 @end deffn
10437
10438 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10439 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10440 in the order they triggered.
10441 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10442 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10443 history records.
10444 @end deffn
10445
10446 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10447 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10448 they have been triggered.
10449 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10450 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10451 and associates it with that identifier.
10452
10453 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10454 are not related except by this command.
10455 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10456 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10457 @end deffn
10458
10459
10460 @node JTAG Commands
10461 @chapter JTAG Commands
10462 @cindex JTAG Commands
10463 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10464 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10465 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10466 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10467 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10468
10469 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10470 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10471
10472 @itemize @bullet
10473 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10474 devices such as a CPUs.
10475 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10476 standard state machine (in parallel)
10477 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10478 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10479 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10480 while the reading previous ones.
10481 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10482 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10483 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10484 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10485 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10486 registers.
10487 @end itemize
10488
10489 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10490
10491 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10492 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10493 the order of TAP state transitions.
10494 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10495 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10496 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10497 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10498 these commands are not available.
10499
10500 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10501 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10502 that specify the entire register.
10503 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10504 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10505 The return value holds the original value of each
10506 of those fields.
10507
10508 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10509 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10510 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10511 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10512 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10513
10514 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10515 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10516
10517 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10518 in that state.
10519 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10520 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10521 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10522
10523 @quotation Warning
10524 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10525 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10526 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10527 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10528 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10529 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10530 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10531 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10532 @end quotation
10533 @end deffn
10534
10535 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10536 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10537 This may be used for performance tuning.
10538
10539 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10540 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10541 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10542 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10543 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10544 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10545 @end deffn
10546
10547 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10548 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10549 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10550 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10551 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10552 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10553
10554 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10555 in that state.
10556 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10557 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10558 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10559
10560 @quotation Note
10561 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10562 register values, unlike data register values.
10563 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10564 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10565 @end quotation
10566 @end deffn
10567
10568 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10569 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10570 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10571 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10572 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10573 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10574 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10575 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10576 The final state must also be stable.
10577 @end deffn
10578
10579 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10580 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10581 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10582 Instructions often need some time
10583 to execute before they take effect.
10584 @end deffn
10585
10586 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10587 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10588
10589 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10590 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10591 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10592 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10593 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10594 @end deffn
10595
10596 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10597 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10598 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10599 must also be enabled.
10600 Default is enabled.
10601 @end deffn
10602
10603 @section TAP state names
10604 @cindex TAP state names
10605
10606 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10607 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10608 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10609 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10610
10611 @itemize @bullet
10612 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10613 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10614 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10615 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10616 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10617 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10618 through the data register
10619 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10620 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10621 for update or more shifting
10622 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10623 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10624 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10625 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10626 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10627 through the instruction register
10628 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10629 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10630 for update or more shifting
10631 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10632 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10633 @end itemize
10634
10635 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10636 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10637 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10638 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10639
10640 @itemize @bullet
10641 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10642 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10643 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10644 may not be as expected.
10645 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10646 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10647 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10648 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10649 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10650 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10651 @end itemize
10652
10653 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10654 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10655
10656 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10657 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10658 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10659 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10660
10661 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10662 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10663 @cindex SVF
10664
10665 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10666 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10667 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10668 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10669
10670 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10671 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10672 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10673 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10674
10675 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10676 affect their semantics.
10677
10678 Command options:
10679 @itemize @minus
10680 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10681 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10682 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10683 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10684 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10685 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10686 on the real interface;
10687 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10688 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10689 errors.
10690 @end itemize
10691 @end deffn
10692
10693 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10694 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10695 @cindex XSVF
10696
10697 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10698 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10699 Xilinx devices.
10700 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10701 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10702
10703 @quotation Important
10704 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10705 @end quotation
10706
10707 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10708 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10709 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10710 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10711 that TAP.
10712 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10713 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10714 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10715 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10716 @end deffn
10717
10718 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10719 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10720 after building the software.
10721 You may find them useful:
10722
10723 @itemize
10724 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10725 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10726 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10727 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10728 @end itemize
10729
10730 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10731 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10732 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10733 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10734 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10735 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10736 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10737
10738
10739 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10740 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10741 @cindex IPDBG
10742
10743 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10744 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10745 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10746 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10747 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10748 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10749
10750 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10751 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10752
10753 Command options:
10754 @itemize @bullet
10755 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10756 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10757 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10758 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10759 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10760 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10761 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10762 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10763 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10764 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10765 shift data through vir can be configured.
10766 @end itemize
10767 @end deffn
10768
10769 Examples:
10770 @example
10771 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10772 @end example
10773 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10774 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10775
10776 @example
10777 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10778 @end example
10779 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10780 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10781
10782 @node Utility Commands
10783 @chapter Utility Commands
10784 @cindex Utility Commands
10785
10786 @section RAM testing
10787 @cindex RAM testing
10788
10789 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10790 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10791 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10792 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10793 hardware problems.
10794
10795 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10796 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10797 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10798 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10799
10800 Load the memory testing functions with
10801
10802 @example
10803 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10804 @end example
10805
10806 to get access to the following facilities:
10807
10808 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10809 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10810 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10811 @end deffn
10812
10813 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10814 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10815 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10816 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10817 @end deffn
10818
10819 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10820 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10821 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10822 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10823 @end deffn
10824
10825 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10826 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10827 @end deffn
10828
10829 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10830 @cindex Firmware recovery
10831
10832 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10833 devices recovery with JTAG.
10834
10835 For quickstart instructions run:
10836 @example
10837 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10838 @end example
10839
10840 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10841 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10842 @cindex GDB
10843 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10844 to debug remote targets.
10845 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10846
10847 @itemize
10848 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10849 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10850 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10851 as shown in this chapter.
10852 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10853 that also will probably need to be configured.
10854 @end itemize
10855
10856 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10857 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10858 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10859 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10860 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10861 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10862
10863 @section Connecting to GDB
10864 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10865 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10866 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10867 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10868 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10869
10870 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10871
10872 @enumerate
10873 @item
10874 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10875 @example
10876 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10877 @end example
10878 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10879
10880 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10881 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10882 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10883
10884 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10885 remote command above that becomes:
10886 @example
10887 tar ext :3333
10888 @end example
10889
10890 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10891 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10892 available through the command:
10893 @example
10894 target remote localhost:3333
10895 @end example
10896
10897 @item
10898 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10899 @example
10900 target extended-remote | \
10901 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10902 @end example
10903 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10904 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10905 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10906 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10907 @end enumerate
10908
10909 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10910 GDB command line.
10911
10912 @section Sample GDB session startup
10913
10914 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10915 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10916 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10917 small ARM program.
10918 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10919 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10920
10921 @example
10922 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10923 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10924 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10925 ...
10926 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10927 ...
10928 (gdb) load
10929 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10930 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10931 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10932 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10933 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10934 (gdb) continue
10935 Continuing.
10936 ...
10937 @end example
10938
10939 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10940 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10941 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10942 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10943
10944 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10945
10946 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10947 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10948 packet size and the device's memory map.
10949 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10950 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10951 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10952
10953 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10954 You may need to set those up by hand.
10955 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10956 something like:
10957
10958 @example
10959 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10960 @end example
10961
10962 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10963
10964 @example
10965 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10966 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10967 @end example
10968
10969 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10970 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10971 do not have such restrictions.
10972
10973 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10974 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10975 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10976 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10977
10978 @section Programming using GDB
10979 @cindex Programming using GDB
10980 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10981
10982 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10983 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10984 @example
10985 gdb_memory_map disable
10986 @end example
10987 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10988 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10989 working area.
10990
10991 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10992 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10993 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10994 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10995
10996 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10997 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10998
10999 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11000 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11001 @example
11002 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11003 @end example
11004
11005 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11006 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11007
11008 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11009 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11010 will be used.
11011
11012 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11013 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11014 @example
11015 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11016 @end example
11017 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11018
11019 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11020 can be used.
11021
11022 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11023 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11024 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11025
11026 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11027 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11028 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11029
11030 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11031 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11032 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11033 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11034 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11035 without any intrusion of the target process.
11036
11037 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11038 Place following command after target configuration:
11039 @example
11040 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11041 @end example
11042
11043 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11044 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11045 @example
11046 gdb_memory_map disable
11047 @end example
11048
11049 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11050 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11051 @example
11052 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11053 @end example
11054
11055 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11056 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11057
11058 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11059 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11060 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11061 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11062
11063 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11064 previously shown variables.
11065
11066 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11067 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11068 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11069 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11070 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11071
11072 @section RTOS Support
11073 @cindex RTOS Support
11074 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11075
11076 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11077 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11078
11079 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11080 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11081 GDB commands.
11082
11083 @* An example setup is below:
11084
11085 @example
11086 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11087 @end example
11088
11089 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11090
11091 Currently supported rtos's include:
11092 @itemize @bullet
11093 @item @option{eCos}
11094 @item @option{ThreadX}
11095 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11096 @item @option{linux}
11097 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11098 @item @option{embKernel}
11099 @item @option{mqx}
11100 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11101 @item @option{nuttx}
11102 @item @option{RIOT}
11103 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11104 @item @option{Zephyr}
11105 @end itemize
11106
11107 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11108 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11109
11110 @table @code
11111 @item eCos symbols
11112 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11113 @item ThreadX symbols
11114 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11115 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11116 @raggedright
11117 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11118 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11119 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11120 @end raggedright
11121 @item linux symbols
11122 init_task.
11123 @item ChibiOS symbols
11124 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11125 @item embKernel symbols
11126 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11127 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11128 @item mqx symbols
11129 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11130 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11131 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11132 @item nuttx symbols
11133 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11134 @item RIOT symbols
11135 @raggedright
11136 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11137 _tcb_name_offset.
11138 @end raggedright
11139 @item Zephyr symbols
11140 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11141 @end table
11142
11143 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11144 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11145
11146 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11147 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11148
11149 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11150 along with the project:
11151
11152 @table @code
11153 @item FreeRTOS
11154 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11155 @item uC/OS-III
11156 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11157 @end table
11158
11159 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11160 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11161 @cindex SMP
11162 @cindex RTOS
11163 @cindex hwthread
11164 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11165 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11166 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11167 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11168 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11169 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11170 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11171 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11172 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11173
11174 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11175 @quotation Note
11176 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11177 @end quotation
11178
11179 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11180 @itemize @bullet
11181 @item j - smp status request
11182 @item J - smp set request
11183 @end itemize
11184
11185 OpenOCD implements :
11186 @itemize @bullet
11187 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11188 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11189 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11190 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11191 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11192 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11193 @end itemize
11194
11195 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11196 @itemize @bullet
11197 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11198 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11199 @example
11200 set $_core 1
11201 #Jc01 packet is sent
11202 print $_core
11203 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11204 @end example
11205
11206 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11207 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11208
11209 @example
11210 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11211 define toggle0
11212 maint packet Jc0
11213 continue
11214 main packet Jc-1
11215 end
11216 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11217 define toggle1
11218 maint packet Jc1
11219 continue
11220 main packet Jc-1
11221 end
11222 @end example
11223 @end itemize
11224
11225 @node Tcl Scripting API
11226 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11227 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11228 @cindex Tcl scripts
11229 @section API rules
11230
11231 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11232 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11233 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11234
11235 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11236 pair list and lists.
11237
11238 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11239 list.
11240
11241 @example
11242 > set foo(me) Duane
11243 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11244 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11245 > set foo(duck) Donald
11246 @end example
11247
11248 If one does this:
11249
11250 @example
11251 > set foo
11252 @end example
11253
11254 The result is:
11255
11256 @example
11257 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11258 @end example
11259
11260 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11261
11262 @verbatim
11263 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11264 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11265 }
11266 @end verbatim
11267
11268 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11269 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11270
11271 @section Internal low-level Commands
11272
11273 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11274 invoke directly.
11275
11276 @itemize @bullet
11277 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11278
11279 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11280 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11281
11282 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11283 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11284
11285 Return information about the flash banks
11286
11287 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11288
11289 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11290 its execution. Example:
11291
11292 @example
11293 > capture "reset init"
11294 @end example
11295
11296 @end itemize
11297
11298 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11299 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11300 called "flash_banks".
11301
11302 @section Tcl RPC server
11303 @cindex RPC
11304
11305 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11306 commands and receive the results.
11307
11308 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11309 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11310 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11311 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11312 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11313
11314 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11315 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11316 @command{capture} command.
11317
11318 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11319
11320 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11321 @cindex RPC Notifications
11322
11323 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11324 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11325
11326 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11327 in the following format.
11328
11329 @verbatim
11330 type target_event event [event-name]
11331 type target_state state [state-name]
11332 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11333 @end verbatim
11334
11335 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11336 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11337 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11338 Defaults to off.
11339
11340 @end deffn
11341
11342 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11343 @cindex RPC trace output
11344
11345 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11346 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11347
11348 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11349
11350 @verbatim
11351 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11352 @end verbatim
11353
11354 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11355 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11356 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11357 Defaults to off.
11358
11359 See an example application here:
11360 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11361
11362 @end deffn
11363
11364 @node FAQ
11365 @chapter FAQ
11366 @cindex faq
11367 @enumerate
11368 @anchor{faqrtck}
11369 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11370 @cindex RTCK
11371 @cindex adaptive clocking
11372 @*
11373
11374 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11375 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11376 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11377 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11378
11379 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11380 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11381 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11382 @enumerate
11383 @item
11384 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11385 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11386 @item
11387 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11388 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11389 @end enumerate
11390
11391 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11392 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11393 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11394 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11395 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11396 power).
11397
11398 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11399 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11400 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11401 ARM926 scenario).
11402 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11403 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11404 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11405
11406 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11407 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11408 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11409 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11410
11411 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11412
11413 In order to make use of this,
11414 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11415 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11416
11417 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11418 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11419 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11420 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11421 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11422
11423 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11424 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11425 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11426 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11427
11428 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11429 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11430 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11431 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11432 with a CPLD.
11433 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11434 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11435 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11436 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11437 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11438 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11439
11440 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11441
11442 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11443
11444 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11445 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11446 depending on the chips on your board.
11447 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11448 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11449 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11450
11451 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11452 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11453 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11454
11455 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11456 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11457 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11458 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11459
11460 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11461 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11462 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11463 this way.
11464
11465 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11466 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11467 clock rate.
11468 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11469 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11470 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11471
11472 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11473
11474 @example
11475 # Example: 1.234MHz
11476 adapter speed 1234
11477 @end example
11478
11479
11480 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11481
11482 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11483 around Windows filenames.
11484
11485 @example
11486 > echo \a
11487
11488 > echo @{\a@}
11489 \a
11490 > echo "\a"
11491
11492 >
11493 @end example
11494
11495
11496 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11497
11498 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11499 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11500 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11501
11502 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11503 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11504 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11505
11506 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11507 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11508 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11509
11510 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11511
11512 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11513 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11514 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11515 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11516
11517 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11518 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11519 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11520
11521 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11522 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11523
11524 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11525 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11526 memory read caused data abort".
11527
11528 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11529 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11530 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11531 be done, feel free to add this here.
11532
11533 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11534 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11535 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11536 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11537 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11538 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11539 gracefully stops.
11540
11541 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11542 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11543 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11544
11545 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11546 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11547 bytes. Painful...
11548
11549
11550 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11551 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11552
11553 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11554 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11555 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11556 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11557 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11558 reset, everything else should work fine.
11559
11560 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11561 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11562 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11563 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11564
11565 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11566 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11567 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11568 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11569
11570 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11571
11572 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11573 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11574 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11575
11576 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11577 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11578
11579 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11580 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11581 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11582 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11583 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11584 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11585 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11586 clock frequency?
11587
11588 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11589 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11590 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11591 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11592 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11593
11594 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11595
11596 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11597 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11598 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11599 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11600 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11601 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11602 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11603
11604 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11605
11606 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11607 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11608 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11609 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11610
11611 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11612 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11613 particular order?
11614
11615 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11616 the same order used by the hardware.
11617
11618 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11619 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11620 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11621 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11622 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11623 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11624
11625 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11626 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11627 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11628 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11629
11630 @itemize @bullet
11631 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11632 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11633 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11634 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11635 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11636 @end itemize
11637
11638 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11639
11640 @itemize @bullet
11641 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11642 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11643 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11644 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11645 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11646 @end itemize
11647
11648
11649 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11650 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11651 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11652
11653 TODO.
11654
11655 @end enumerate
11656
11657 @node Tcl Crash Course
11658 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11659 @cindex Tcl
11660
11661 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11662 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11663 how the Tcl scripts work.
11664
11665 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11666 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11667 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11668 OpenOCD.
11669
11670 @section Tcl Rule #1
11671 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11672 @enumerate
11673 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11674 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11675 @end enumerate
11676
11677 The Tcl equal is this:
11678
11679 @enumerate
11680 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11681 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11682 @end enumerate
11683
11684 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11685 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11686
11687 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11688 There is a second pair of rules.
11689 @enumerate
11690 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11691 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11692 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11693 in Tcl.
11694 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11695 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11696 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11697 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11698 @end enumerate
11699
11700 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11701 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11702 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11703 Everything is a string}
11704
11705 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11706 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11707 difference is subtle.
11708 @enumerate
11709 @item Parse Time
11710 @item Evaluation Time
11711 @end enumerate
11712
11713 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11714 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11715 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11716
11717 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11718 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11719 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11720 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11721
11722 @itemize @bullet
11723 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11724 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11725 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11726 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11727 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11728 @example
11729 # bash example
11730 X=`date`
11731 echo "The Date is: $X"
11732 # Tcl example
11733 set X [date]
11734 puts "The Date is: $X"
11735 @end example
11736 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11737 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11738 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11739 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11740 is a string}
11741 @example
11742 set x "Dinner"
11743 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11744 @end example
11745 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11746 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11747 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11748 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11749 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11750 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11751 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11752 @end itemize
11753
11754 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11755
11756 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11757
11758 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11759
11760 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11761 the normal way.
11762
11763 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11764 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11765 line is immediately executed.
11766
11767 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11768 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11769
11770 @subsection Command Execution
11771
11772 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11773 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11774 control flow operators.
11775
11776 Commands are executed like this:
11777
11778 @enumerate
11779 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11780 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11781 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11782 @end enumerate
11783
11784 It sort of works like this:
11785 @example
11786 for(;;)@{
11787 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11788
11789 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11790
11791 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11792 @}
11793 @end example
11794
11795 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11796 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11797 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11798 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11799 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11800 ``LookupCommand()''
11801
11802 @subsection The FOR command
11803
11804 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11805 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11806 command just like any other command.
11807
11808 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11809 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11810 are:
11811
11812 @enumerate 0
11813 @item The ascii text 'for'
11814 @item The start text
11815 @item The test expression
11816 @item The next text
11817 @item The body text
11818 @end enumerate
11819
11820 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11821 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11822 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11823 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11824
11825 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11826 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11827
11828 @example
11829 int
11830 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11831 int *argc,
11832 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11833 @end example
11834
11835 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11836 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11837 still operates in the same basic way.
11838
11839 @subsection FOR command implementation
11840
11841 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11842 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11843
11844 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11845
11846 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11847
11848 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11849 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11850 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11851
11852 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11853 expression and returns a value.
11854
11855 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11856 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11857 @example
11858 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11859
11860 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11861
11862 int
11863 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11864 int argc,
11865 char **argv )
11866 @{
11867 if( argc != 5 )@{
11868 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11869 return ERROR;
11870 @}
11871
11872 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11873
11874 // Execute the start statement.
11875 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11876
11877 // Top of loop test
11878 for(;;)@{
11879 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11880 if( i == 0 )
11881 break;
11882
11883 // Execute the body
11884 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11885
11886 // Execute the LOOP part
11887 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11888 @}
11889
11890 // Return no error
11891 SetResult( interp, "" );
11892 return SUCCESS;
11893 @}
11894 @end example
11895
11896 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11897 in the same basic way.
11898
11899 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11900
11901 @subsection source and find commands
11902 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11903 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11904 @*Remember the parsing rules
11905 @enumerate
11906 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11907 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11908 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11909 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11910 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11911 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11912 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11913 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11914 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11915 @end enumerate
11916 @subsection format command
11917 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11918 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11919 @b{sprintf()}.
11920 @b{Example}
11921 @example
11922 set x 6
11923 set y 7
11924 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11925 @end example
11926 @enumerate
11927 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11928 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11929 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11930 @* Refer to Rule #1
11931 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11932 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11933 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11934 @end enumerate
11935 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11936 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11937 @example
11938 #1 Good
11939 proc someproc @{@} @{
11940 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11941 @}
11942 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11943 #2 Good - no variables
11944 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11945 #3 Good Curly Braces
11946 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11947 puts "Time: [date]"
11948 @}
11949 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11950 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11951 @end example
11952 @enumerate
11953 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11954 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11955 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11956 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11957 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11958 command.
11959 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11960 @*There are 4 examples:
11961 @enumerate
11962 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11963 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11964 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11965 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11966 @end enumerate
11967
11968 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11969 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11970 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11971
11972 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11973 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11974 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11975 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11976 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11977 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11978 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11979 @end enumerate
11980 @subsection Global Variables
11981 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11982 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11983 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11984 @example
11985 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11986 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11987 global x #Global variable X
11988 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11989 @}
11990 @end example
11991 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11992 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11993 @example
11994 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11995 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11996 # Create var name
11997 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11998 # Make it a global
11999 global $vn
12000 # Set it.
12001 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12002 @}
12003 @end example
12004 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12005 @example
12006 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12007 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12008 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12009 @}
12010 @end example
12011
12012 @node License
12013 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12014 @include fdl.texi
12015
12016 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12017 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12018 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12019 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12020 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12021 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12022
12023 @printindex cp
12024
12025 @node Command and Driver Index
12026 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12027 @printindex fn
12028
12029 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)